blob: 0b4844b184b27fee2dc080068dea5f742b61f237 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaueab1dc62013-06-17 15:10:25 +02007 2013/06/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200458 - node
459 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100460 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200462 * Performance tuning
463 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200464 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100465 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100466 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100467 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200468 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - noepoll
470 - nokqueue
471 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200473 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200474 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200475 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100476 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100477 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200478 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100479 - tune.maxaccept
480 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200481 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200482 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100483 - tune.rcvbuf.client
484 - tune.rcvbuf.server
485 - tune.sndbuf.client
486 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100487 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100488 - tune.ssl.lifetime
489 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100490 - tune.zlib.memlevel
491 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493 * Debugging
494 - debug
495 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200496
497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004983.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499------------------------------------
500
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200501ca-base <dir>
502 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200503 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
504 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506chroot <jail dir>
507 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
508 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
509 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
510 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
511 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
512 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100513
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100514cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
515 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
516 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
517 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
518 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
519 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
520 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
521 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
522 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
523 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
524 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
525 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
526 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
527 they overlap.
528
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200529crt-base <dir>
530 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
531 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
532 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200534daemon
535 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
536 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
537 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
538
539gid <number>
540 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
541 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
542 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100543 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
544 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547group <group name>
548 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
549 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100550
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200551log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
553 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100554 configured with "log global".
555
556 <address> can be one of:
557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100558 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100559 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
560 port).
561
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100562 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
563 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
564 port).
565
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100566 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
567 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
568 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
569 writeable).
570
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100571 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
572 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
573 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
574 in Bourne shell.
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577
578 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
579 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
580 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
581
582 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200583 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
584 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
585 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
586 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
587 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
588 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200590 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100592log-send-hostname [<string>]
593 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
594 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
595 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
596 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
597 the logs.
598
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000599log-tag <string>
600 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
601 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
602 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
603 running on the same host.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605nbproc <number>
606 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
607 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
608 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
609 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
610 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
611
612pidfile <pidfile>
613 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
614 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
615 starting the process. See also "daemon".
616
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100617stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200618 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
619 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
620 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
621 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
622 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
623 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
624 the number of processes used.
625
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200626stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
627 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
628 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
629 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
630 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200631
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200632 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
633 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
634 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200635
636stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
637 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
638 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100639 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200640
641stats maxconn <connections>
642 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
643 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645uid <number>
646 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
647 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
648 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
649 one. See also "gid" and "user".
650
651ulimit-n <number>
652 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
653 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
654 option.
655
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100656unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
657 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
658
659 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
660 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
661 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
662 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
663 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
664 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
665 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
666 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
667 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
668 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670user <user name>
671 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
672 See also "uid" and "group".
673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200674node <name>
675 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
676
677 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
678 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
679 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
680 traffic.
681
682description <text>
683 Add a text that describes the instance.
684
685 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
686 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
687 "<" and ">" characters.
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006903.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691-----------------------
692
693maxconn <number>
694 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
695 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
696 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
697 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
698
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200699maxconnrate <number>
700 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
701 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
702 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
703 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
704 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
705 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
706 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
707 fairness.
708
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100709maxcomprate <number>
710 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
711 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
712 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
713 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
714 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
715 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
716 default value.
717
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100718maxcompcpuusage <number>
719 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
720 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
721 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
722 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
723 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
724 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
725 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
726 process down and from introducing high latencies.
727
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100728maxpipes <number>
729 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
730 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
731 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
732 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
733 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
734 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
735
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200736maxsslconn <number>
737 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
738 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
739 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
740 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
741 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
742 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
743 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
744
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100745maxzlibmem <number>
746 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
747 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
748 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100749 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
750 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
751 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
752
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753noepoll
754 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
755 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100756 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
758nokqueue
759 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
760 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
761 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
762
763nopoll
764 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
765 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100766 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100767 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100769nosplice
770 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
771 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
772 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100773 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100774 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
775 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
776 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
777 "option splice-response".
778
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200779spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
780 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
781 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
782 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
783 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
784 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
785
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200786tune.bufsize <number>
787 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
788 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
789 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
790 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
791 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
792 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
793 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
794 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400795 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
796 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
797 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200798
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200799tune.chksize <number>
800 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
801 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
802 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
803 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
804 checks whenever possible.
805
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100806tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
807 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
808 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
809 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
810 this value. The default value is 1.
811
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100812tune.http.cookielen <number>
813 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
814 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
815 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
816 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
817 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
818 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
819 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
820 to change this value.
821
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200822tune.http.maxhdr <number>
823 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
824 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
825 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
826 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
827 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
828 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
829 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
830 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
831 limit too high.
832
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100833tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100834 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
835 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
836 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
837 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
838 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
839 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
840 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
841 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
842 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
843 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100844
845tune.maxpollevents <number>
846 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
847 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
848 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
849 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
850 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
851
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200852tune.maxrewrite <number>
853 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
854 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
855 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
856 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
857 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
858 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
859 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
860 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
861 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
862 bufsize.
863
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200864tune.pipesize <number>
865 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
866 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
867 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
868 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
869 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
870 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
871
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100872tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
873tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
874 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
875 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
876 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
877 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
878 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
879 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
880 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
881
882tune.sndbuf.client <number>
883tune.sndbuf.server <number>
884 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
885 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
886 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
887 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
888 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
889 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
890 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
891 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
892 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
893 notifying haproxy again.
894
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100895tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100896 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
897 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
898 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
899 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
900 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
901 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
902 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
903 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
904 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100905 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
906 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100907
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100908tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
909 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
910 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
911 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
912 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
913 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
914 being used for too long.
915
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100916tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
917 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
918 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
919 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
920 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
921 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
922 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
923 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
924 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
925 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
926 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
927 best value.
928
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100929tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
930 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
931 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
932 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
933 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
934 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
935
936tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
937 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
938 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
939 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
940 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009423.3. Debugging
943--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200944
945debug
946 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
947 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
948 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
949 system startup.
950
951quiet
952 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
953 line argument "-q".
954
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009563.4. Userlists
957--------------
958It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
959http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
960it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
961
962userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100963 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100964 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
965
966group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100967 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100968 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
969 proceeded by "users" keyword.
970
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100971user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
972 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100973 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
974 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100975 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
976 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100977 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
978 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
979
980
981 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100982 userlist L1
983 group G1 users tiger,scott
984 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100985
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100986 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
987 user scott insecure-password elgato
988 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100989
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100990 userlist L2
991 group G1
992 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100993
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100994 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
995 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
996 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100997
998 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200999
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001000
10013.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001002----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001003It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1004haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1005pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1006identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1007or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1008Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1009known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1010the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1011process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1012during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1013tables.
1014
1015peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001016 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001017 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1018
1019peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1020 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1021 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1022 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1023 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1024 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1025 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1026
1027 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1028 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1029
1030 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1031 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1032 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1033 across all peers.
1034
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001035 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1036 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1037 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1038
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001039 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001040 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001041 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1042 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1043 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001044
1045 backend mybackend
1046 mode tcp
1047 balance roundrobin
1048 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1049 stick on src
1050
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001051 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1052 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001053
1054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010554. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001057
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001058Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1059 - defaults <name>
1060 - frontend <name>
1061 - backend <name>
1062 - listen <name>
1063
1064A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1065its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1066section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001067section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
1069A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1070connections.
1071
1072A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1073to forward incoming connections.
1074
1075A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1076parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001078All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1079'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1080case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1081
1082Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1083logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1084proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1085However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1086name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1087
1088Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1089and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001090bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001091protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1092modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1093arbitrary criteria.
1094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010964.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1097--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001099The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1100limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1101they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1102limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001103marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001104option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001105and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1106with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1107specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001108
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001110 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1111------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1112acl - X X X
1113appsession - - X X
1114backlog X X X -
1115balance X - X X
1116bind - X X -
1117bind-process X X X X
1118block - X X X
1119capture cookie - X X -
1120capture request header - X X -
1121capture response header - X X -
1122clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001123compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001124contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1125cookie X - X X
1126default-server X - X X
1127default_backend X X X -
1128description - X X X
1129disabled X X X X
1130dispatch - - X X
1131enabled X X X X
1132errorfile X X X X
1133errorloc X X X X
1134errorloc302 X X X X
1135-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1136errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001137force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001138fullconn X - X X
1139grace X X X X
1140hash-type X - X X
1141http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001142http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001143http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001144http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001145http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001146http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001147id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001148ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001149log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001150maxconn X X X -
1151mode X X X X
1152monitor fail - X X -
1153monitor-net X X X -
1154monitor-uri X X X -
1155option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1156option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1157option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1158option allbackups (*) X - X X
1159option checkcache (*) X - X X
1160option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1161option contstats (*) X X X -
1162option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1163option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1164option forceclose (*) X X X X
1165-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1166option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001167option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001168option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001169option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1170option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1171option httpchk X - X X
1172option httpclose (*) X X X X
1173option httplog X X X X
1174option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001175option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09001176option lb-agent-chk X - X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001177option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001178option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1179option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1180option logasap (*) X X X -
1181option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001182option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001183option nolinger (*) X X X X
1184option originalto X X X X
1185option persist (*) X - X X
1186option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001187option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001188option smtpchk X - X X
1189option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1190option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1191option splice-request (*) X X X X
1192option splice-response (*) X X X X
1193option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1194option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1195-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1196option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1197option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1198option tcpka X X X X
1199option tcplog X X X X
1200option transparent (*) X - X X
1201persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1202rate-limit sessions X X X -
1203redirect - X X X
1204redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1205redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1206reqadd - X X X
1207reqallow - X X X
1208reqdel - X X X
1209reqdeny - X X X
1210reqiallow - X X X
1211reqidel - X X X
1212reqideny - X X X
1213reqipass - X X X
1214reqirep - X X X
1215reqisetbe - X X X
1216reqitarpit - X X X
1217reqpass - X X X
1218reqrep - X X X
1219-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1220reqsetbe - X X X
1221reqtarpit - X X X
1222retries X - X X
1223rspadd - X X X
1224rspdel - X X X
1225rspdeny - X X X
1226rspidel - X X X
1227rspideny - X X X
1228rspirep - X X X
1229rsprep - X X X
1230server - - X X
1231source X - X X
1232srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001233stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001234stats auth X - X X
1235stats enable X - X X
1236stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001237stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001238stats realm X - X X
1239stats refresh X - X X
1240stats scope X - X X
1241stats show-desc X - X X
1242stats show-legends X - X X
1243stats show-node X - X X
1244stats uri X - X X
1245-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1246stick match - - X X
1247stick on - - X X
1248stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001249stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001250stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001251tcp-request connection - X X -
1252tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001253tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001254tcp-response content - - X X
1255tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001256timeout check X - X X
1257timeout client X X X -
1258timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1259timeout connect X - X X
1260timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1261timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1262timeout http-request X X X X
1263timeout queue X - X X
1264timeout server X - X X
1265timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1266timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001267timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001268transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001269unique-id-format X X X -
1270unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001271use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001272use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001273------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1274 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012774.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1278---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001279
1280This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1281
1282
1283acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1284 Declare or complete an access list.
1285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1286 no | yes | yes | yes
1287 Example:
1288 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1289 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1290 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001292 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001293
1294
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001295appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1296 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001297 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1299 no | no | yes | yes
1300 Arguments :
1301 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1302 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1303
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001304 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001305 checked in each cookie value.
1306
1307 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1308 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1309 milliseconds.
1310
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001311 request-learn
1312 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1313 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1314 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1315 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1316 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1317 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1318
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001319 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1320 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1321 data following this prefix.
1322
1323 Example :
1324 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1325
1326 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1327 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1328
1329 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1330 2 modes are currently supported :
1331 - path-parameters :
1332 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1333 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1334 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1335 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1336 - query-string :
1337 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1338 query string.
1339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001340 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1341 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1342 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1343 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001344 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1345 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1346 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001347 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1348 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1349
1350 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1351
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001352 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1353 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1354 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001356 Example :
1357 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1358
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001359 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1360 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001361
1362
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001363backlog <conns>
1364 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1366 yes | yes | yes | no
1367 Arguments :
1368 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1369 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001370 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001371
1372 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1373 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1374 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1375 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1376 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1377 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1378 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1379 backlog parameter.
1380
1381 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1382 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1383 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1384
1385 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1386
1387
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001388balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001389balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001390 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1392 yes | no | yes | yes
1393 Arguments :
1394 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1395 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1396 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1397 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1398
1399 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1400 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1401 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1402 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001403 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001404 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001405 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1406 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1407 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1408 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1409 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1410 it, so that you don't worry.
1411
1412 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1413 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1414 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1415 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1416 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1417 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1418 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1419 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001421 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1422 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1423 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1424 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1425 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1426 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1427 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1428 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1429
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001430 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1431 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1432 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1433 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001434 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001435 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1436 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1437 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1438 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1439 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001440 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1441 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1442 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1443 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1444 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1445 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001447 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1448 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1449 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1450 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1451 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1452 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1453 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1454 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001455 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001457 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1458 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1459 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001460
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001461 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1462 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1463 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1464 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1465 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1466 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1467 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1468 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1469 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1470 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1471 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1472 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001474 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001475 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1476 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1477 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1478 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1479 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1480 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1481 URIs start with a leading "/".
1482
1483 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1484 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1485 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1486 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1487
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001488 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001489 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1490
1491 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001492 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1493 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1494 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1495 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1496 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1497 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1498 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1499 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1500 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1501 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1502 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1503 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1504 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1505 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1506 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1507 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1508 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1509 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1510 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001511
1512 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1513 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1514 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1515 server will receive the request.
1516
1517 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1518 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1519 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1520 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1521 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001522 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1523 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1524 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001525
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001526 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1527 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1528 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1529 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1530 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001531
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001532 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001533 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1534 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1535 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1536
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001537 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1538 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1539 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1540
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001541 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001542 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001543 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1544 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1545 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1546 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1547 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1548 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001549 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001550 used instead.
1551
1552 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1553 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1554 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1555 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1556
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001557 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1558 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1559 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1560
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001561 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001562
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001563 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001564 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1565 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001566
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001567 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001568 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001569
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001570 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1571 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1572 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001573
1574 Examples :
1575 balance roundrobin
1576 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001577 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001578 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1579 balance hdr(host)
1580 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001581
1582 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1583 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001585 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001586 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1587 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1588 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1589 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1590
1591 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1592 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1593 defaults to 16 kB.
1594
1595 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1596 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1597
1598 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1599 Round Robin.
1600
1601 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1602 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1603 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1604 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1605
1606 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1607
1608 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001609 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001610 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1611 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1612 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001613
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001614 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1615 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001616
1617
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001618bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1619bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001620 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1622 no | yes | yes | no
1623 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001624 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1625 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1626 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1627 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001628 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001629 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1630 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1631 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1632 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1633 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1634 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1635 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001636 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1637 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1638 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001639 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1640 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1641 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1642 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001643
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001644 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1645 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001646 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1647 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1648 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001649 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1650 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1651 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1652 the range.
1653
1654 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1655 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1656 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1657 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1658 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1659 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1660 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001661 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001662 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001663
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001664 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1665 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1666 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1667 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1668 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1669 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1670 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1671 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1672
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001673 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1674 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1675 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1676 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001678 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1679 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1680 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1681 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1682 in a frontend.
1683
1684 Example :
1685 listen http_proxy
1686 bind :80,:443
1687 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001688 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001689
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001690 listen http_https_proxy
1691 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001692 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001693
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001694 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1695 bind ipv6@:80
1696 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1697 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1698
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001699 listen external_bind_app1
1700 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1701
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001702 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001703 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704
1705
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001706bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001707 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1709 yes | yes | yes | yes
1710 Arguments :
1711 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1712 may be used to override a default value.
1713
1714 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1715 option may be combined with other numbers.
1716
1717 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1718 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1719 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1720 missing from all processes.
1721
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001722 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1723 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1724 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1725 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1726 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001727
1728 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1729 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1730 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1731 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1732 and 'even' instances.
1733
1734 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1735 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1736 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1737 32.
1738
1739 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1740 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1741
1742 Example :
1743 listen app_ip1
1744 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001745 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001746
1747 listen app_ip2
1748 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001749 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001750
1751 listen management
1752 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001753 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001754
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001755 listen management
1756 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1757 bind-process 1-4
1758
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001759 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1760
1761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762block { if | unless } <condition>
1763 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1765 no | yes | yes | yes
1766
1767 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1768 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001769 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001770 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1772 "block" statements per instance.
1773
1774 Example:
1775 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1776 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1777 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1778 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001780 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781
1782
1783capture cookie <name> len <length>
1784 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1786 no | yes | yes | no
1787 Arguments :
1788 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1789 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1790 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1791 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1792 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1793
1794 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1795 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1796 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1797 right if it exceeds <length>.
1798
1799 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1800 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1801 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1802 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1803
1804 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1805 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1806 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1807
1808 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1809 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1810 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001811 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1812 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1813 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814
1815 Example:
1816 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1817
1818 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001819 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001820
1821
1822capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001823 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1825 no | yes | yes | no
1826 Arguments :
1827 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001828 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001829 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1830 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1831 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1832
1833 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1834 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1835 it exceeds <length>.
1836
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001837 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001838 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1839 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001840 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1841 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1842 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1843 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001844 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001845 environments to find where the request came from.
1846
1847 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1848 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1849 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1850 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001851
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001852 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1853 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1854 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1855 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1856 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
1858 Example:
1859 capture request header Host len 15
1860 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1861 capture request header Referrer len 15
1862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001863 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001864 about logging.
1865
1866
1867capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001868 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1870 no | yes | yes | no
1871 Arguments :
1872 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001873 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001874 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1875 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1876 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1877
1878 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1879 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1880 it exceeds <length>.
1881
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001882 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1884 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1885 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001886 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1887 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1888 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1889 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001890
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001891 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1892 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1893 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1894 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1895 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001896
1897 Example:
1898 capture response header Content-length len 9
1899 capture response header Location len 15
1900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001901 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001902 about logging.
1903
1904
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001905clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1908 yes | yes | yes | no
1909 Arguments :
1910 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1911 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1912 as explained at the top of this document.
1913
1914 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1915 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1916 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1917 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1918 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1919 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1920 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1921 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001922 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001923 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1924 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1925
1926 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1927 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1928 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1929 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1930 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1931 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1932
1933 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1934 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1935
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001936 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1937 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001939compression algo <algorithm> ...
1940compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001941compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001942 Enable HTTP compression.
1943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1944 yes | yes | yes | yes
1945 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001946 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1947 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1948 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1949
1950 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001951 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001952 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1953 data.
1954
1955 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1956 support for zlib was built in.
1957
1958 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1959 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1960 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1961 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1962 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1963 in.
1964
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001965 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001966 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001967 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1968 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1969 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1970 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1971 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001972
1973 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1974 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1975 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1976 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1977 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001978 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1979 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1980 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1981 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1982 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1983 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001984
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001985 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001986 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1987 "Accept-Encoding" header
1988 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001989 * HTTP status code is not 200
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001990 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1991 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1992 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
1993 "multipart"
1994 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
1995 header
1996 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
1997 and later
1998 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
1999 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002000
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002001 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2002 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002003
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002004 Examples :
2005 compression algo gzip
2006 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002008contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002009 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2011 yes | no | yes | yes
2012 Arguments :
2013 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2014 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2015 as explained at the top of this document.
2016
2017 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002018 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002019 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2021 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2022 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2023 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2024
2025 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2026 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2027 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2028 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2029 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2030 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2031
2032 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2033 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2034 instead.
2035
2036 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2037 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2038
2039
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002040cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002041 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2042 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2045 yes | no | yes | yes
2046 Arguments :
2047 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2048 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2049 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2050 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2051 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2052 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2053 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2054 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2055 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2056
2057 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2058 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2059 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2060 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2061 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2062 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2063 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2064 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2065 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2066 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2067 "insert" and "prefix".
2068
2069 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002070 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002071
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002072 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002073 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2074 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2075 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2076 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2077 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2078 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2079 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2080 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2081 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2082 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083
2084 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2085 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2086 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2087 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2088 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2089 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2090 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2091 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2092 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2093 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002094 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2095 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2096 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002098 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2099 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2100 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002101 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2102 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2103 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2104 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002105 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2106 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2107 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002108
2109 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2110 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2111 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2112 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2113 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2114 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2115 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2116 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2117 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2118
2119 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2120 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2121 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2122 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2123 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2124 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2125 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2126 persistence cookie in the cache.
2127 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2128
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002129 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2130 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2131 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2132 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2133 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2134 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2135 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2136 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2137 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2138 they logout.
2139
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002140 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2141 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2142 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2143 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2144
2145 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2146 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2147 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2148 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2149 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2150 this attribute.
2151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002152 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002153 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002154 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2155 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2156 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2157 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2158 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2159 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002160
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002161 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2162 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2163 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2164 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2165 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2166 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2167 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2168 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2169 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2170 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2171 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2172 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2173 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2174 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2175 the site.
2176
2177 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2178 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2179 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2180 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2181 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2182 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2183 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2184 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2185 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2186 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2187 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2188 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2189 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2190 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2191 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2192 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2193
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002194 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2195 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2196 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2197 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002198
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002199 Examples :
2200 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2201 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2202 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002203 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002205 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002206 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002207
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002209default-server [param*]
2210 Change default options for a server in a backend
2211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2212 yes | no | yes | yes
2213 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002214 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2215 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2216 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2217 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002218
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002219 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002220 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2221
2222 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002223
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002224
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002225default_backend <backend>
2226 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2228 yes | yes | yes | no
2229 Arguments :
2230 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2231
2232 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2233 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2234 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2235 will catch all undetermined requests.
2236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002237 Example :
2238
2239 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2240 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2241 default_backend dynamic
2242
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002243 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2244
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002246description <string>
2247 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2249 no | yes | yes | yes
2250 Arguments : string
2251
2252 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2253 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2254 it describes.
2255 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2256
2257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002258disabled
2259 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2261 yes | yes | yes | yes
2262 Arguments : none
2263
2264 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2265 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2266 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2267 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2268 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2269 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2270 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2271
2272 See also : "enabled"
2273
2274
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002275dispatch <address>:<port>
2276 Set a default server address
2277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2278 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002279 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002280
2281 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2282 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2283 during start-up.
2284
2285 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2286 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2287 possible with normal servers.
2288
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002289 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002290 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2291 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2292 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2293 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2294
2295 See also : "server"
2296
2297
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298enabled
2299 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2301 yes | yes | yes | yes
2302 Arguments : none
2303
2304 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2305 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2306
2307 See also : "disabled"
2308
2309
2310errorfile <code> <file>
2311 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2313 yes | yes | yes | yes
2314 Arguments :
2315 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002316 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002317
2318 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002319 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002321 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2322 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323
2324 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2325 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2326 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2327
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002328 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2329
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002330 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2331 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2332 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2333 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2334
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002335 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2336 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2337 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2338 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2339 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2340 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2343 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2344 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002345 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002346 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2347
2348 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2349
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002350 Example :
2351 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2352 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2353 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2354
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002355
2356errorloc <code> <url>
2357errorloc302 <code> <url>
2358 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2360 yes | yes | yes | yes
2361 Arguments :
2362 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002363 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002364
2365 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2366 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2367 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2368 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2369 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2370
2371 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2372 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2373 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2374
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002375 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2376
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002377 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2378 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2379 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2380 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2381 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2382 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2383 request.
2384
2385 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2386
2387
2388errorloc303 <code> <url>
2389 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2391 yes | yes | yes | yes
2392 Arguments :
2393 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2394 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2395
2396 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2397 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2398 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2399 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2400 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2401
2402 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2403 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2404 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2405
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002406 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2407
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002408 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2409 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2410 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2411 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002412 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002413
2414 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2415
2416
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002417force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2418 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2419 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2420 no | yes | yes | yes
2421
2422 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2423 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2424 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2425 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2426 marked down for maintenance operations.
2427
2428 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2429 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2430 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2431 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2432 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2433 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2434 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2435 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2436 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2437
2438 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2439 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2440 is used.
2441
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002442 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002443 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002444
2445
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002446fullconn <conns>
2447 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2449 yes | no | yes | yes
2450 Arguments :
2451 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2452 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2453
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002454 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002455 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002456 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002457 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2458 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2459 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2460 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2461 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002462 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002463
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002464 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2465 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2466 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002468 Example :
2469 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2470 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2471 # connections.
2472 backend dynamic
2473 fullconn 10000
2474 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2475 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2476
2477 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2478
2479
2480grace <time>
2481 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002483 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002484 Arguments :
2485 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2486 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2487 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2488
2489 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2490 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002491 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002492 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2493
2494 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2495 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2496 simplify it.
2497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002498
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002499hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002500 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2502 yes | no | yes | yes
2503 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002504 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2505 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002506
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002507 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2508 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2509 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2510 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2511 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2512 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2513 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2514 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2515 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2516 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002517
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002518 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2519 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2520 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2521 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2522 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2523 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2524 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2525 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2526 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2527 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2528 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2529 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2530 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002531 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2532 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002533
2534 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2535
2536 sdbm this function was created intially for sdbm (a public-domain
2537 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2538 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2539 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002540 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2541 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2542 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002543
2544 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2545 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002546 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2547 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2548 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2549 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2550
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002551 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2552 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2553 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2554 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2555 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2556 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2557 parameter.
2558
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002559 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2560
2561 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2562 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2563 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2564 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2565 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2566 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2567 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2568 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2569 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2570 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2571 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2572 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002573
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002574 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2575 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2576 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002577
2578 See also : "balance", "server"
2579
2580
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002581http-check disable-on-404
2582 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002584 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002585 Arguments : none
2586
2587 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2588 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2589 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2590 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2591 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2592 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2593 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2594 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002595 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2596 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2597 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2598
2599 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2600
2601
2602http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002603 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002605 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002606 Arguments :
2607 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2608 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002609 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002610 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2611 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2612 details on the supported keywords.
2613
2614 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2615 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2616 with the usual backslash ('\').
2617
2618 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2619 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2620 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2621 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2622 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2623
2624 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002625 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002626 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2627 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2628 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2629
2630 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002631 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002632 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2633 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2634 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2635 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2636
2637 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002638 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002639 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2640 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2641 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2642 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2643 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2644 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2645 trace).
2646
2647 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002648 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002649 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2650 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2651 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2652 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2653 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2654 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2655
2656 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2657 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2658 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2659 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2660 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2661 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2662 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2663 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2664
2665 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2666 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2667
2668 Examples :
2669 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002670 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002671
2672 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002673 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002674
2675 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002676 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002677
2678 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002679 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002681 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002682
2683
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002684http-check send-state
2685 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2687 yes | no | yes | yes
2688 Arguments : none
2689
2690 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2691 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2692 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2693 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2694 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2695
2696 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2697 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2698 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2699 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2700 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2701 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2702 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2703 checked in multiple backends.
2704
2705 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2706 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2707
2708 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2709 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2710 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2711 one fails.
2712
2713 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2714 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2715 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2716
2717 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2718 server's queue.
2719
2720 Example of a header received by the application server :
2721 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2722 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2723
2724 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2725
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002726http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002727 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002728 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2729 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002730 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002731 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2732
2733 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2734 no | yes | yes | yes
2735
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002736 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2737 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2738 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2739 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2740 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002741
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002742 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2743 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2744 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2745
2746 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2747 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2748 are evaluated.
2749
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002750 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2751 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2752 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2753 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2754 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2755 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2756 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2757 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2758 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2759 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2760 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2761
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002762 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2763 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2764 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2765 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2766 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2767
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002768 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2769 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2770 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
2771 "http-request" rules. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
2772
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002773 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2774 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2775 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2776 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2777 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2778 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2779 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2780 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2781
2782 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2783 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2784 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2785 external users.
2786
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002787 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2788 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2789 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2790 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2791 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2792 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2793 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2794 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2795
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002796 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2797 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2798 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2799 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2800 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2801 another equipment.
2802
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002803 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2804 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2805 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2806 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2807 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2808 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2809 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2810 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2811
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002812 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2813 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2814 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2815 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2816 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2817 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2818 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2819 admin privileges.
2820
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002821 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2822
2823 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2824 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2825 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2826 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002827
2828 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002829 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2830 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2831 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002832
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002833 http-request allow if nagios
2834 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2835 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2836 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002837
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002838 Example:
2839 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002840 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002841
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002842 Example:
2843 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2844 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2845 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2846 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2847 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2848 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2849 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2850 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2851 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2852
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002853 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2854 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002855
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002856http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002857 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002858 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2859 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002860 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2861
2862 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2863 no | yes | yes | yes
2864
2865 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2866 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2867 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2868 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2869 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2870 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2871
2872 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2873 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2874 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2875 current section.
2876
2877 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2878 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2879 rules are evaluated.
2880
2881 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2882 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2883 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2884 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2885 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2886 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2887 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2888
2889 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2890 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2891 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2892 external users.
2893
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002894 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2895 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2896 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2897 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2898 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2899 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2900 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2901 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2902
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002903 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2904 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2905 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2906 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2907 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2908 another equipment.
2909
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002910 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2911 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2912 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2913 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2914 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2915 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2916 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2917 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2918
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002919 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2920 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2921 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2922 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2923 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2924 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2925 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2926 admin privileges.
2927
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002928 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2929
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08002930 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002931 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2932 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2933 rules.
2934
2935 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2936 ACL usage.
2937
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002938http-send-name-header [<header>]
2939 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2940
2941 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2942 yes | no | yes | yes
2943
2944 Arguments :
2945
2946 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2947
2948 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2949 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2950 is added with the header string proved.
2951
2952 See also : "server"
2953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002954id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002955 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2957 no | yes | yes | yes
2958 Arguments : none
2959
2960 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2961 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2962 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002963
2964
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002965ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2966 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2967 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2968 no | yes | yes | yes
2969
2970 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2971 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2972 and running).
2973
2974 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2975 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2976 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2977 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2978 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2979
2980 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2981 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2982
2983 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2984 "unless" condition is met.
2985
2986 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2987
2988
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002989log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002990log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002991no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002992 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2994 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002995
2996 Prefix :
2997 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2998 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2999 prefix does not allow arguments.
3000
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003001 Arguments :
3002 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3003 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3004 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3005 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3006 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3007 parameter.
3008
3009 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3010 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3011
3012 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3013 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3014 standard syslog port).
3015
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003016 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3017 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3018 standard syslog port).
3019
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003020 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3021 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3022 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3023 appropriately writeable).
3024
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003025 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3026 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3027 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3028 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3029
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003030 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3031
3032 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3033 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3034 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3035
3036 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3037 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3038 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003039 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3040 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3041 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3042 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3043 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003044
3045 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3046
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003047 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3048 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3049 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003050
3051 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3052 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3053 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3054 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3055
3056 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3057 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003058
3059 Example :
3060 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003061 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3062 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003063 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3064
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003065
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003066log-format <string>
3067 Allows you to custom a log line.
3068
3069 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3070
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003071
3072maxconn <conns>
3073 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3075 yes | yes | yes | no
3076 Arguments :
3077 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3078 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3079 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3080 closes.
3081
3082 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3083 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3084 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3085 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3086 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3087 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3088 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3089 properly tuned.
3090
3091 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3092 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3093 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3094
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003095 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3096
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003097 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3098
3099
3100mode { tcp|http|health }
3101 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3103 yes | yes | yes | yes
3104 Arguments :
3105 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3106 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3107 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3108 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3109
3110 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3111 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3112 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3113 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3114 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3115
3116 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003117 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3118 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3119 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3120 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3121 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3122 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3123 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003124
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003125 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3126 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3127 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003128
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003129 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003130 defaults http_instances
3131 mode http
3132
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003133 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003135
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003136monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003137 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3139 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003140 Arguments :
3141 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3142 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003143 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3145 backend and its backup.
3146
3147 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3148 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3149 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3150 servers in a list of backends.
3151
3152 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3153 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3154 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3155 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3156 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3157 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3158 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003159 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3160 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003161
3162 Example:
3163 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003164 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003165 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3166 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3167 monitor-uri /site_alive
3168 monitor fail if site_dead
3169
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003170 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003171
3172
3173monitor-net <source>
3174 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3176 yes | yes | yes | no
3177 Arguments :
3178 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3179 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3180 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3181 followed by a mask.
3182
3183 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3184 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003185 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003186 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3187
3188 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3189 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3190 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3191 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003192 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3193 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3194 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003195
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003196 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3197 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3198 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3199 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3200 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3201 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003202
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003203 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3204 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003205
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003206 Example :
3207 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3208 frontend www
3209 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3210
3211 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3212
3213
3214monitor-uri <uri>
3215 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3217 yes | yes | yes | no
3218 Arguments :
3219 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3220 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3221
3222 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3223 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3224 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3225 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3226 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3227 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3228 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3229 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3230
3231 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3232 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3233 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3234 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3235 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3236 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3237
3238 Example :
3239 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3240 frontend www
3241 mode http
3242 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3243
3244 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3245
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003246
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003247option abortonclose
3248no option abortonclose
3249 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3251 yes | no | yes | yes
3252 Arguments : none
3253
3254 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3255 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3256 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3257 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003258 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003259 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3260 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3261 encountered while delivering the response.
3262
3263 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3264 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3265 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3266 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3267 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3268 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003269 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003270 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003271 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003272 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3273 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3274 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3275
3276 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3277 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3278 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3279 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3280 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3281 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3282 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3283 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003284 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003285
3286 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3287 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3288
3289 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3290
3291
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003292option accept-invalid-http-request
3293no option accept-invalid-http-request
3294 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3296 yes | yes | yes | no
3297 Arguments : none
3298
3299 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3300 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3301 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3302 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3303 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3304 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3305 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3306 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003307 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3308 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3309 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3310 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3311 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3312 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003313
3314 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3315 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3316 been confirmed.
3317
3318 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3319 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003320 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3321 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003322 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3323
3324 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3325 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3326
3327 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3328 stats socket.
3329
3330
3331option accept-invalid-http-response
3332no option accept-invalid-http-response
3333 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3335 yes | no | yes | yes
3336 Arguments : none
3337
3338 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3339 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3340 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3341 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3342 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3343 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3344 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3345 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3346 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3347
3348 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3349 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3350 been confirmed.
3351
3352 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3353 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3354 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3355 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3356
3357 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3358 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3359
3360 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3361 stats socket.
3362
3363
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003364option allbackups
3365no option allbackups
3366 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3368 yes | no | yes | yes
3369 Arguments : none
3370
3371 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3372 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3373 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3374 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3375 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3376 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3377 order between the backup servers anymore.
3378
3379 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3380 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3381
3382 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3383 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3384
3385
3386option checkcache
3387no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003388 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3390 yes | no | yes | yes
3391 Arguments : none
3392
3393 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3394 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003395 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003396 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3397 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003398 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003399
3400 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003401 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003402 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003403 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3404 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003405 to the client are :
3406 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003407 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003408 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003409 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3410 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3411 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3412 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3413 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3414 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3415 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3416 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3417 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3418 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3419 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3420
3421 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003422 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003423 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003424 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003425 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3426
3427 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3428 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003429 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003430 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3431
3432 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3433 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3434
3435
3436option clitcpka
3437no option clitcpka
3438 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3440 yes | yes | yes | no
3441 Arguments : none
3442
3443 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3444 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3445 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3446 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3447
3448 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3449 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3450 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3451 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3452
3453 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3454 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3455 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3456 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3457 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3458
3459 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3460
3461 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3462 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3463 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3464
3465 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3466 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3467
3468 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3469
3470
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003471option contstats
3472 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3474 yes | yes | yes | no
3475 Arguments : none
3476
3477 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3478 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3479 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3480 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3481 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3482 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3483 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3484
3485
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003486option dontlog-normal
3487no option dontlog-normal
3488 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3490 yes | yes | yes | no
3491 Arguments : none
3492
3493 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3494 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3495 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3496 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3497 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3498 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3499 logged.
3500
3501 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3502 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3503 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003505 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003506 logging.
3507
3508
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003509option dontlognull
3510no option dontlognull
3511 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3513 yes | yes | yes | no
3514 Arguments : none
3515
3516 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3517 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3518 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3519 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3520 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3521 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3522 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3523
3524 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3525 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3526 would not be logged.
3527
3528 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3529 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003531 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003532
3533
3534option forceclose
3535no option forceclose
3536 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003538 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003539 Arguments : none
3540
3541 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3542 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3543 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3544 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3545 global session times in the logs.
3546
3547 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003548 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003549 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3550 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3551 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3552 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003553
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003554 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3555 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3556 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3557
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003558 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3559 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3560
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003561 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003562
3563
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003564option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003565 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3567 yes | yes | yes | yes
3568 Arguments :
3569 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3570 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003571 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003572 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003573
3574 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3575 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3576 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3577 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3578 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3579 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3580 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003581 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3582 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3583 possible that the client has already brought one.
3584
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003585 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003586 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003587 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3588 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003589 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3590 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003591
3592 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3593 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3594 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3595 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3596 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3597 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3598 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3599
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003600 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3601 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3602 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3603 are under the control of the end-user.
3604
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003605 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003606 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3607 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003608 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3609 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3610 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003611
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003612 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3613 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3614 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3615 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3616 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003617
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003618 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003619 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3620 frontend www
3621 mode http
3622 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3623
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003624 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3625 backend www
3626 mode http
3627 option forwardfor header X-Client
3628
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003629 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3630 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003631
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003632
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003633option http-no-delay
3634no option http-no-delay
3635 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3637 yes | yes | yes | yes
3638 Arguments : none
3639
3640 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3641 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3642 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3643 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3644 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3645 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3646 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3647 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3648 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3649 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3650 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3651 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3652 affected.
3653
3654 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3655 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3656 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3657 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3658 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3659 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3660 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3661 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3662 latency environments.
3663
3664
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003665option http-pretend-keepalive
3666no option http-pretend-keepalive
3667 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3669 yes | yes | yes | yes
3670 Arguments : none
3671
3672 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3673 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3674 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3675 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3676 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3677 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3678 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3679 consider the response complete.
3680
3681 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3682 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3683 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3684 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3685 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3686 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3687
3688 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3689 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3690 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3691 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3692 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3693 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3694 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3695
3696 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3697 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003698 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003699 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3700 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003701
3702 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3703 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3704
3705 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3706
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003707
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003708option http-server-close
3709no option http-server-close
3710 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3712 yes | yes | yes | yes
3713 Arguments : none
3714
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003715 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3716 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3717 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3718 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3719 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3720 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3721 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3722 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3723 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3724 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3725 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3726 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003727
3728 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3729 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3730 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3731 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003732 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3733 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003734
3735 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3736 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003737 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3738 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3739 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003740
3741 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3742 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3743
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003744 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3745 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003746
3747
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003748option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003749no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003750 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3752 yes | yes | yes | no
3753 Arguments : none
3754
3755 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3756 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3757 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3758 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3759 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3760 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3761 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3762
3763 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3764 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3765 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3766 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3767 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3768 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3769 request along its whole life.
3770
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003771 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3772 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3773 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3774 front of an existing proxy.
3775
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003776 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3777
3778 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3779 http-server-close".
3780
3781
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003782option httpchk
3783option httpchk <uri>
3784option httpchk <method> <uri>
3785option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3786 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3788 yes | no | yes | yes
3789 Arguments :
3790 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3791 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3792 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3793 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3794 ones.
3795
3796 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3797 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3798 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3799
3800 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3801 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3802 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3803 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3804 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3805
3806 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3807 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3808 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3809 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3810 the lack of any response.
3811
3812 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3813
3814 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3815 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3816 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3817
3818 Examples :
3819 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3820 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3821 backend https_relay
3822 mode tcp
3823 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3824 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3825
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003826 See also : "option lb-agent-chk", "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk",
3827 "option mysql-check", "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and
3828 the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003829
3830
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003831option httpclose
3832no option httpclose
3833 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3835 yes | yes | yes | yes
3836 Arguments : none
3837
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003838 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3839 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3840 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3841 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3842 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3843 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3844 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003845
3846 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003847 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003848 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3849 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3850 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3851 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3852 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003853
3854 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3855 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3856 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003857 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3858 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003859
3860 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3861 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3862
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003863 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3864 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003865
3866
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003867option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003868 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3870 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003871 Arguments :
3872 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3873 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3874 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3875 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3876 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003877
3878 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3879 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3880 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3881 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3882 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3883 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3884 ports.
3885
3886 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3887
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3890 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3891 by default.
3892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003893 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003894
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003895
3896option http_proxy
3897no option http_proxy
3898 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3900 yes | yes | yes | yes
3901 Arguments : none
3902
3903 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3904 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3905 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3906 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3907 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3908
3909 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3910 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3911 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3912 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003913 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003914 be analyzed.
3915
3916 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3917 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3918
3919 Example :
3920 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3921 backend direct_forward
3922 option httpclose
3923 option http_proxy
3924
3925 See also : "option httpclose"
3926
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003927
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003928option independent-streams
3929no option independent-streams
3930 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3932 yes | yes | yes | yes
3933 Arguments : none
3934
3935 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3936 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3937 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3938 receive data or not.
3939
3940 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3941 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3942 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3943 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3944 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3945 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3946 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3947 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3948 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3949 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3950 socket buffers.
3951
3952 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3953 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3954 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3955 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3956 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3957
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003958 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3959 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3960 deprecated.
3961
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003962 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003963
3964
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003965option lb-agent-chk
3966 Use a TCP connection to obtain a metric of server health
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3968 yes | no | yes | yes
3969 Arguments : none
3970
3971 This alters health checking behaviour by connecting making a TCP
3972 connection and reading an ASCII string. The string should have one of
3973 the following forms:
3974
3975 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
3976 e.g. "75%"
3977
3978 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
3979 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
3980
3981 * The string "drain".
3982
3983 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
3984 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
3985 persistence.
3986
3987 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
3988
3989 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
3990
3991 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
3992
3993 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3994
3995 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
3996
3997 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3998
3999 The use of an alternate check-port, used to obtain agent heath check
4000 information described above as opposed to the port of the service, may be
4001 useful in conjunction with this option.
4002
4003
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004004option ldap-check
4005 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4007 yes | no | yes | yes
4008 Arguments : none
4009
4010 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4011 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4012 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4013 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4014
4015 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4016 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4017
4018 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4019 configure it.
4020
4021 Example :
4022 option ldap-check
4023
4024 See also : "option httpchk"
4025
4026
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004027option log-health-checks
4028no option log-health-checks
4029 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4031 yes | no | yes | yes
4032 Arguments : none
4033
4034 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4035 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4036 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4037 of additional information is limited.
4038
4039 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4040 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4041
4042 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4043
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004044
4045option log-separate-errors
4046no option log-separate-errors
4047 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4049 yes | yes | yes | no
4050 Arguments : none
4051
4052 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4053 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4054 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4055 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4056 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4057 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4058 provides very important information.
4059
4060 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4061 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4062 error logs.
4063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004064 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004065 logging.
4066
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004067
4068option logasap
4069no option logasap
4070 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4072 yes | yes | yes | no
4073 Arguments : none
4074
4075 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4076 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4077 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4078 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4079 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4080 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4081 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004082 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004083 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4084 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4085
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004086 Examples :
4087 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4088 mode http
4089 option httplog
4090 option logasap
4091 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4092
4093 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4094 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4095 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4096 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004098 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004099 logging.
4100
4101
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004102option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4103 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4105 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004106 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004107 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4108 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004109
4110 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4111 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4112 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4113 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4114 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4115 in the MySQL table, like this :
4116
4117 USE mysql;
4118 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4119 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4120
4121 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4122 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4123 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4124 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4125 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4126 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4127 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4128 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4129 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4130
4131 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4132 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004133
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004134 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004135
4136 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4137 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4138 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4139 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4140 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4141 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4142
4143 See also: "option httpchk"
4144
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004145option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4146 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4148 yes | no | yes | yes
4149 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004150 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4151 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004152
4153 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4154 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4155 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4156 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4157
4158 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004159
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004160option nolinger
4161no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004162 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4164 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004165 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004166
4167 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4168 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4169 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4170 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4171 connections.
4172
4173 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4174 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4175 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4176 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4177 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4178 this too.
4179
4180 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4181 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4182 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4183
4184 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4185 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4186 for servers.
4187
4188 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4189 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4190
4191
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004192option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4193 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4195 yes | yes | yes | yes
4196 Arguments :
4197 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4198 matching <network>
4199 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4200 header name.
4201
4202 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4203 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4204 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4205 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4206 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4207 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4208 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4209 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4210 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4211 possible that the client has already brought one.
4212
4213 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4214 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4215 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4216 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4217 header and requires different one.
4218
4219 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4220 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4221 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4222 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4223 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4224 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4225 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4226
4227 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4228 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4229 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4230 both are defined.
4231
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004232 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4233 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4234 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4235 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4236 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004237
4238 Examples :
4239 # Original Destination address
4240 frontend www
4241 mode http
4242 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4243
4244 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4245 backend www
4246 mode http
4247 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4248
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004249 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4250 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004251
4252
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004253option persist
4254no option persist
4255 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4256 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4257 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004258 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004259
4260 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4261 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4262 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4263 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4264 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4265 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4266 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4267 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4268 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4269 redirected to another valid server.
4270
4271 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4272 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4273
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004274 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004275
4276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004277option redispatch
4278no option redispatch
4279 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4280 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4281 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004282 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004283
4284 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4285 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4286 be able to access the service anymore.
4287
4288 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4289 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4290
4291 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4292 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4293 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004295 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4296 "redisp" keywords.
4297
4298 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4299 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4300
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004301 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004302
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004303
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004304option redis-check
4305 Use redis health checks for server testing
4306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4307 yes | no | yes | yes
4308 Arguments : none
4309
4310 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4311 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4312 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4313 find the "+PONG" response message.
4314
4315 Example :
4316 option redis-check
4317
4318 See also : "option httpchk"
4319
4320
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004321option smtpchk
4322option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4323 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4325 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004326 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004327 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4328 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4329 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4330
4331 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4332 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4333 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4334
4335 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4336 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4337 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4338 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4339 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4340 dead server.
4341
4342 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4343 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4344 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4345 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4346
4347 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4348 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4349 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4350 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4351 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4352
4353 Example :
4354 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4355
4356 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004358
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004359option socket-stats
4360no option socket-stats
4361
4362 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4364 yes | yes | yes | no
4365
4366 Arguments : none
4367
4368
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004369option splice-auto
4370no option splice-auto
4371 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4373 yes | yes | yes | yes
4374 Arguments : none
4375
4376 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4377 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4378 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4379 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004380 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004381 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4382 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4383 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4384 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4385
4386 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4387 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4388 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4389 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4390 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4391 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4392 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4393 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4394 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4395 keyword.
4396
4397 Example :
4398 option splice-auto
4399
4400 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4401 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4402
4403 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4404 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4405
4406
4407option splice-request
4408no option splice-request
4409 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 yes | yes | yes | yes
4412 Arguments : none
4413
4414 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004415 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004416 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4417 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4418 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4419 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4420
4421 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4422
4423 Example :
4424 option splice-request
4425
4426 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4427 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4428
4429 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4430 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4431
4432
4433option splice-response
4434no option splice-response
4435 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4437 yes | yes | yes | yes
4438 Arguments : none
4439
4440 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004441 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004442 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4443 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4444 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4445 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4446
4447 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4448
4449 Example :
4450 option splice-response
4451
4452 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4453 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4454
4455 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4456 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4457
4458
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004459option srvtcpka
4460no option srvtcpka
4461 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4463 yes | no | yes | yes
4464 Arguments : none
4465
4466 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4467 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4468 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4469 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4470
4471 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4472 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4473 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4474 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4475
4476 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4477 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4478 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4479 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4480 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4481
4482 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4483
4484 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4485 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4486 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4487
4488 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4489 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4490
4491 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4492
4493
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004494option ssl-hello-chk
4495 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4497 yes | no | yes | yes
4498 Arguments : none
4499
4500 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4501 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4502 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4503 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4504 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4505 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4506 hello message.
4507
4508 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4509 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4510 messages, which is appreciable.
4511
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004512 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4513 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4514 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004515
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004516 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4517
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004518
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004519option tcp-smart-accept
4520no option tcp-smart-accept
4521 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4523 yes | yes | yes | no
4524 Arguments : none
4525
4526 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4527 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4528 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4529 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4530 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4531 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4532
4533 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4534 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4535 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4536 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4537
4538 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4539 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4540 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4541 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4542
4543 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4544 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4545 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4546
4547 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4548 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4549 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4550
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004551 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4552
4553
4554option tcp-smart-connect
4555no option tcp-smart-connect
4556 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4558 yes | no | yes | yes
4559 Arguments : none
4560
4561 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4562 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4563 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4564 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4565 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4566
4567 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4568 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4569 complex.
4570
4571 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4572 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4573 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4574
4575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4577
4578 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4579
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004580
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004581option tcpka
4582 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4584 yes | yes | yes | yes
4585 Arguments : none
4586
4587 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4588 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4589 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4590 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4591
4592 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4593 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4594 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4595 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4596
4597 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4598 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4599 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4600 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4601 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4602
4603 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4604
4605 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4606 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4607 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4608 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4609 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4610 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4611 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4612 backends.
4613
4614 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4615
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004616
4617option tcplog
4618 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 yes | yes | yes | yes
4621 Arguments : none
4622
4623 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4624 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4625 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4626 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4627 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4628 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4629 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4630 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4631
4632 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004634 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004635
4636
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004637option transparent
4638no option transparent
4639 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004641 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004642 Arguments : none
4643
4644 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4645 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4646 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4647 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4648 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4649 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4650 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4651 appropriate server.
4652
4653 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4654 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4655
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004656 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004657 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004658
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004659
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004660persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004661persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004662 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4664 yes | no | yes | yes
4665 Arguments :
4666 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004667 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4668 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004669
4670 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4671 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4672 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4673 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4674 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4675 forwarded to this server.
4676
4677 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4678 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4679 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004680 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004681 a single "listen" section.
4682
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004683 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4684 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4685 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4686
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004687 Example :
4688 listen tse-farm
4689 bind :3389
4690 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4691 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4692 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4693 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4694 persist rdp-cookie
4695 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004696 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004697 balance rdp-cookie
4698 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4699 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4700
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004701 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4702 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004703
4704
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004705rate-limit sessions <rate>
4706 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4708 yes | yes | yes | no
4709 Arguments :
4710 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4711 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4712
4713 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4714 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4715 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4716 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4717 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4718 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4719
4720 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4721 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4722 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4723 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4724
4725 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4726 listen smtp
4727 mode tcp
4728 bind :25
4729 rate-limit sessions 10
4730 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4731
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004732 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4733 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4734 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004735
4736 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4737
4738
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004739redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4740redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4741redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004742 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4744 no | yes | yes | yes
4745
4746 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004747 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004748
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004749 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004750 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4751 the HTTP "Location" header.
4752
4753 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4754 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4755 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4756 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4757 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4758 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4759
4760 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4761 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4762 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4763 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4764 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4765 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4766 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4767 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4768 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004769
4770 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01004771 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
4772 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
4773 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
4774 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
4775 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
4776 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
4777 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
4778 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004779
4780 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4781 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4782
4783 - "drop-query"
4784 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4785 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4786 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4787 with a location-type redirect.
4788
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004789 - "append-slash"
4790 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4791 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4792 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4793 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4794
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004795 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4796 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4797 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4798 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4799 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4800 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4801 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4802
4803 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4804 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4805 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4806 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4807 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4808 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4809 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004810
4811 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4812 acl clear dst_port 80
4813 acl secure dst_port 8080
4814 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004815 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004816 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004817 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4818
4819 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004820 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4821 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4822 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004823 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004824
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004825 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4826 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4827 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4828
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004829 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004830 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004832 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004833
4834
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004835redisp (deprecated)
4836redispatch (deprecated)
4837 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4839 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004840 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004841
4842 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4843 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4844 be able to access the service anymore.
4845
4846 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4847 redistribute them to a working server.
4848
4849 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4850 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4851 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004853 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4854 "option redispatch" instead.
4855
4856 See also : "option redispatch"
4857
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004858
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004859reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004860 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4862 no | yes | yes | yes
4863 Arguments :
4864 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4865 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004866 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004867
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004868 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4869 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4870
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004871 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4872 the last header of an HTTP request.
4873
4874 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4875 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4876 responses.
4877
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004878 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4879 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4880 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4881
4882 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4883 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004884
4885
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004886reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4887reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004888 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4890 no | yes | yes | yes
4891 Arguments :
4892 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4893 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4894 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4895 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4896 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4897 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4898 ignores case.
4899
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004900 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4901 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4902
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004903 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4904 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4905 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4906 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004907 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004908
4909 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4910 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4911
4912 Example :
4913 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4914 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4915 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4916
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004917 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4918 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004919
4920
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004921reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4922reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004923 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4925 no | yes | yes | yes
4926 Arguments :
4927 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4928 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4929 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4930 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4931 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4932 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4933
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004934 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4935 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4936
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004937 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4938 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4939 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4940 next servers.
4941
4942 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4943 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4944 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4945
4946 Example :
4947 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4948 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4949 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4950
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004951 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4952 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004953
4954
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004955reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4956reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004957 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4959 no | yes | yes | yes
4960 Arguments :
4961 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4962 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4963 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4964 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4965 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4966 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4967 case.
4968
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004969 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4970 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4971
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004972 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4973 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4974 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4975 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004976 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004977
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004978 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004979 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004980 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004981
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004982 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4983 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4984
4985 Example :
4986 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4987 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4988 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4989
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004990 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4991 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004992
4993
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004994reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4995reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004996 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4998 no | yes | yes | yes
4999 Arguments :
5000 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5001 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5002 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5003 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5004 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5005 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5006 case.
5007
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005008 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5009 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5010
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005011 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5012 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5013 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5014 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5015
5016 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5017 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5018
5019 Example :
5020 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5021 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5022 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5023 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5024
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005025 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5026 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005027
5028
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005029reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5030reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005031 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5033 no | yes | yes | yes
5034 Arguments :
5035 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5036 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5037 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5038 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5039 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5040 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5041
5042 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5043 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5044 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5045 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005046 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005047
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005048 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5049 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5050
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005051 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5052 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5053 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5054
5055 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5056 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5057 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5058 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5059 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5060
5061 Example :
5062 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005063 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005064 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5065 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5066
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005067 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5068 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005069
5070
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005071reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5072reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005073 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5075 no | yes | yes | yes
5076 Arguments :
5077 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5078 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5079 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5080 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5081 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5082 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5083 ignores case.
5084
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005085 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5086 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5087
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005088 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5089 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005090 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5091 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5092 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005093 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5094 not set.
5095
5096 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5097 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5098 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5099 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5100 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5101
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005102 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005103 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5104 # block all others.
5105 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5106 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5107
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005108 # block bad guys
5109 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5110 reqitarpit . if badguys
5111
5112 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5113 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005114
5115
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005116retries <value>
5117 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5118 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5119 yes | no | yes | yes
5120 Arguments :
5121 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5122 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5123 default value is 3.
5124
5125 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5126 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5127 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5128
5129 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5130 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5131
5132 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5133 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5134
5135 See also : "option redispatch"
5136
5137
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005138rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005139 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5141 no | yes | yes | yes
5142 Arguments :
5143 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5144 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005145 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005146
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005147 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5148 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5149
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005150 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5151 the last header of an HTTP response.
5152
5153 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5154 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5155 responses.
5156
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005157 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5158 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005159
5160
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005161rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5162rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005163 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5165 no | yes | yes | yes
5166 Arguments :
5167 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5168 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5169 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5170 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5171 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5172 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5173 ignores case.
5174
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005175 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5176 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5177
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005178 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5179 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005180 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005181 client.
5182
5183 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5184 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5185 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5186
5187 Example :
5188 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005189 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005190
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005191 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5192 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005193
5194
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005195rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5196rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005197 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5199 no | yes | yes | yes
5200 Arguments :
5201 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5202 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5203 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5204 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5205 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5206 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5207 ignores case.
5208
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005209 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5210 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5211
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005212 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5213 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5214 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5215 case-sensitive.
5216
5217 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005218 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5219 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5220 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005221
5222 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5223 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5224
5225 Example :
5226 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5227 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5228
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005229 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5230 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005231
5232
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005233rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5234rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005235 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5237 no | yes | yes | yes
5238 Arguments :
5239 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5240 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5241 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5242 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5243 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5244 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5245 ignores case.
5246
5247 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5248 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5249 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5250 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005251 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005252
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005253 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5254 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5255
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005256 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5257 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5258 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5259
5260 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5261 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5262 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5263 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5264 are not case-sensitive.
5265
5266 Example :
5267 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5268 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5269
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005270 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5271 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005272
5273
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005274server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005275 Declare a server in a backend
5276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5277 no | no | yes | yes
5278 Arguments :
5279 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005280 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005281 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005282
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005283 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5284 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5285 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5286 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005287 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5288 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5289 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5290 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5291 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005292 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5293 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5294 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5295 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5296 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5297 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5298 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005299 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5300 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5301 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5302 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005303
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005304 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005305 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5306 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5307 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5308 adding this value to the client's port.
5309
5310 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5311 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005312 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005313
5314 Examples :
5315 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5316 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005317 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005318 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5319 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5320 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005321
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005322 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5323 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005324
5325
5326source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005327source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005328source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005329 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5331 yes | no | yes | yes
5332 Arguments :
5333 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5334 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005335
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005336 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005337 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5338 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5339 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5340 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5341 supported prefixes are :
5342 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5343 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5344 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005345 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5346 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5347 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5348 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005349
5350 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5351 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005352 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5353 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5354 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005355
5356 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5357 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5358 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5359 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5360 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5361 <addr>.
5362
5363 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5364 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5365 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5366 port.
5367
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005368 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5369 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5370 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5371 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005372 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005373 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5374 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5375 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5376 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5377 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5378 HTTP header.
5379
5380 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5381 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005382 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005383 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5384 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5385 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5386 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5387 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5388 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5389 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5390
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005391 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5392 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5393 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5394 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5395 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5396 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5397
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005398 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5399 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5400 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5401 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5402
5403 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5404 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5405 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5406 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5407 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5408 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5409
5410 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5411 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5412 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5413 there are two methods :
5414
5415 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5416 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5417 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5418 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5419 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5420 of the client ranges may be used.
5421
5422 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5423 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5424 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5425 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5426 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5427 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5428 same session.
5429
5430 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5431 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5432 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5433 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5434 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5435 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5436
5437 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5438 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5439 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005440 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005441
5442 Examples :
5443 backend private
5444 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5445 source 192.168.1.200
5446
5447 backend transparent_ssl1
5448 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5449 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5450
5451 backend transparent_ssl2
5452 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5453 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5454 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5455
5456 backend transparent_ssl3
5457 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5458 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5459 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5460
5461 backend transparent_smtp
5462 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5463 # with Tproxy version 4.
5464 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5465
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005466 backend transparent_http
5467 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5468 # proxy.
5469 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005471 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005472 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5473
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005474
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005475srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5476 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5478 yes | no | yes | yes
5479 Arguments :
5480 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5481 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5482 as explained at the top of this document.
5483
5484 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5485 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5486 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5487 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5488 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5489 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5490 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5491
5492 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5493 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5494 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5495 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5496 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005497 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005498 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005499 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005500
5501 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5502 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5503 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5504 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5505 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5506 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5507
5508 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5509 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5510
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005511 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5512 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005513
5514
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005515stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5516 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5518 no | no | yes | yes
5519
5520 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5521 matched.
5522
5523 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5524 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5525
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005526 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5527 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5528 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5529
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005530 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5531 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5532 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5533 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005534
5535 Example :
5536 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5537 backend stats_localhost
5538 stats enable
5539 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5540
5541 Example :
5542 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5543 backend stats_auth
5544 stats enable
5545 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5546 stats admin if TRUE
5547
5548 Example :
5549 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5550 userlist stats-auth
5551 group admin users admin
5552 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5553 group readonly users haproxy
5554 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5555
5556 backend stats_auth
5557 stats enable
5558 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5559 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5560 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5561 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5562
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005563 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5564 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5565 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005566
5567
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005568stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5569 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5571 yes | no | yes | yes
5572 Arguments :
5573 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5574
5575 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5576
5577 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5578 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5579 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5580 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5581 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5582 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5583
5584 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5585 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5586 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005587 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005588
5589 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5590 report using "stats scope".
5591
5592 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5593 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5594 unobvious parameters.
5595
5596 Example :
5597 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5598 backend public_www
5599 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5600 stats enable
5601 stats hide-version
5602 stats scope .
5603 stats uri /admin?stats
5604 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5605 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5606 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5607
5608 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5609 backend private_monitoring
5610 stats enable
5611 stats uri /admin?stats
5612 stats refresh 5s
5613
5614 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5615
5616
5617stats enable
5618 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5620 yes | no | yes | yes
5621 Arguments : none
5622
5623 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5624 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5625 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5626 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5627 - stats auth : no authentication
5628 - stats scope : no restriction
5629
5630 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5631 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5632 unobvious parameters.
5633
5634 Example :
5635 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5636 backend public_www
5637 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5638 stats enable
5639 stats hide-version
5640 stats scope .
5641 stats uri /admin?stats
5642 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5643 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5644 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5645
5646 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5647 backend private_monitoring
5648 stats enable
5649 stats uri /admin?stats
5650 stats refresh 5s
5651
5652 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5653
5654
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005655stats hide-version
5656 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5658 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005659 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005660
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005661 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5662 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5663 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5664 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5665 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5666 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005668 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5669 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5670 unobvious parameters.
5671
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005672 Example :
5673 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5674 backend public_www
5675 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005676 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005677 stats hide-version
5678 stats scope .
5679 stats uri /admin?stats
5680 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5681 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5682 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005683
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005684 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5685 backend private_monitoring
5686 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005687 stats uri /admin?stats
5688 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005689
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005690 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005691
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005692
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005693stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5694 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5695 Access control for statistics
5696
5697 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5698 no | no | yes | yes
5699
5700 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5701 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5702 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5703 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5704 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5705 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5706
5707 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5708 instance.
5709
5710 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5711 about ACL usage.
5712
5713
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005714stats realm <realm>
5715 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5717 yes | no | yes | yes
5718 Arguments :
5719 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5720 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5721 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5722
5723 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5724 using a backslash ('\').
5725
5726 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5727 only related to authentication.
5728
5729 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5730 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5731 unobvious parameters.
5732
5733 Example :
5734 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5735 backend public_www
5736 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5737 stats enable
5738 stats hide-version
5739 stats scope .
5740 stats uri /admin?stats
5741 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5742 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5743 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5744
5745 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5746 backend private_monitoring
5747 stats enable
5748 stats uri /admin?stats
5749 stats refresh 5s
5750
5751 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5752
5753
5754stats refresh <delay>
5755 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5757 yes | no | yes | yes
5758 Arguments :
5759 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5760 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5761 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5762 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5763 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5764 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5765
5766 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5767 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5768 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5769 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5770
5771 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5772 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5773 unobvious parameters.
5774
5775 Example :
5776 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5777 backend public_www
5778 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5779 stats enable
5780 stats hide-version
5781 stats scope .
5782 stats uri /admin?stats
5783 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5784 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5785 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5786
5787 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5788 backend private_monitoring
5789 stats enable
5790 stats uri /admin?stats
5791 stats refresh 5s
5792
5793 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5794
5795
5796stats scope { <name> | "." }
5797 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5799 yes | no | yes | yes
5800 Arguments :
5801 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5802 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5803 section in which the statement appears.
5804
5805 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5806 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5807 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5808 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5809 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5810 exists.
5811
5812 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5813 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5814 unobvious parameters.
5815
5816 Example :
5817 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5818 backend public_www
5819 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5820 stats enable
5821 stats hide-version
5822 stats scope .
5823 stats uri /admin?stats
5824 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5825 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5826 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5827
5828 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5829 backend private_monitoring
5830 stats enable
5831 stats uri /admin?stats
5832 stats refresh 5s
5833
5834 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5835
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005836
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005837stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005838 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5840 yes | no | yes | yes
5841
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005842 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005843 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5844
5845 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5846 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5847
5848 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5849 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005850 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005851
5852 Example :
5853 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5854 backend private_monitoring
5855 stats enable
5856 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5857 stats uri /admin?stats
5858 stats refresh 5s
5859
5860 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5861 global section.
5862
5863
5864stats show-legends
5865 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5866 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5867 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5868 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5869 - IP (socket, server)
5870 - cookie (backend, server)
5871
5872 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5873 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005874 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005875
5876 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5877
5878
5879stats show-node [ <name> ]
5880 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5882 yes | no | yes | yes
5883 Arguments:
5884 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5885 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5886
5887 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5888 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005889 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005890
5891 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5892 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5893 unobvious parameters.
5894
5895 Example:
5896 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5897 backend private_monitoring
5898 stats enable
5899 stats show-node Europe-1
5900 stats uri /admin?stats
5901 stats refresh 5s
5902
5903 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5904 section.
5905
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005906
5907stats uri <prefix>
5908 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5910 yes | no | yes | yes
5911 Arguments :
5912 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5913 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5914 query string.
5915
5916 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5917 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5918 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5919 possible to reach it in the application.
5920
5921 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005922 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005923 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5924 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5925 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5926 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5927
5928 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5929 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5930 an address or a port to statistics only.
5931
5932 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5933 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5934 unobvious parameters.
5935
5936 Example :
5937 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5938 backend public_www
5939 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5940 stats enable
5941 stats hide-version
5942 stats scope .
5943 stats uri /admin?stats
5944 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5945 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5946 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5947
5948 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5949 backend private_monitoring
5950 stats enable
5951 stats uri /admin?stats
5952 stats refresh 5s
5953
5954 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5955
5956
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005957stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5958 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005960 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005961
5962 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02005963 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005964 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5965 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5966 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5967
5968 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5969 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5970 the "stick-table" statement.
5971
5972 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5973 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5974 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5975 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5976 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5977
5978 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5979 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5980 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5981 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5982 transformation rules.
5983
5984 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5985 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5986 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5987 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5988 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5989 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5990 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5991
5992 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5993 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5994 ACL based conditions.
5995
5996 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5997 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5998 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5999 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6000
6001 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6002 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6003 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6004 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6005
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006006 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6007 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6008 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6009
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006010 Example :
6011 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6012 # last 30 minutes
6013 backend pop
6014 mode tcp
6015 balance roundrobin
6016 stick store-request src
6017 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6018 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6019 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6020
6021 backend smtp
6022 mode tcp
6023 balance roundrobin
6024 stick match src table pop
6025 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6026 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6027
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006028 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6029 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006030
6031
6032stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6033 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6035 no | no | yes | yes
6036
6037 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6038 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6039 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6040 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6041
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006042 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6043 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6044 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6045
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006046 Examples :
6047 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006048 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006049
6050 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6051 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6052 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6053
6054
6055 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6056 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6057 backend http
6058 mode http
6059 balance roundrobin
6060 stick on src table https
6061 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6062 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6063 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6064
6065 backend https
6066 mode tcp
6067 balance roundrobin
6068 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6069 stick on src
6070 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6071 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6072
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006073 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006074
6075
6076stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6077 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6079 no | no | yes | yes
6080
6081 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006082 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006083 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6084 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6085 server is selected.
6086
6087 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6088 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6089 the "stick-table" statement.
6090
6091 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6092 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6093 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6094 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6095 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6096 address.
6097
6098 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6099 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6100 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6101 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6102 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6103 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6104 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6105 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6106 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6107 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6108
6109 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6110 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6111 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6112 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6113 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6114 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6115 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6116
6117 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6118 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6119 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6120 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6121
6122 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6123 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6124 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6125 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6126 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6127 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6128 another protocol or access method.
6129
6130 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6131 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6132 the request.
6133
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006134 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6135 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6136 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6137
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006138 Example :
6139 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6140 # last 30 minutes
6141 backend pop
6142 mode tcp
6143 balance roundrobin
6144 stick store-request src
6145 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6146 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6147 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6148
6149 backend smtp
6150 mode tcp
6151 balance roundrobin
6152 stick match src table pop
6153 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6154 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6155
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006156 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6157 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006158
6159
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006160stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006161 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6162 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006163 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
6164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006165 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006166
6167 Arguments :
6168 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6169 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6170 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6171 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6172
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006173 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6174 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6175 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6176 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6177
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006178 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6179 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6180 instance.
6181
6182 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6183 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6184 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6185 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6186 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6187 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006188 to 32 characters.
6189
6190 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6191 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6192 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6193 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6194 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6195 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006196
6197 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006198 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6199 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006200 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6201 increase.
6202
6203 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006204 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6205 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6206 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006207
6208 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6209 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6210 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6211 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6212 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6213 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6214 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6215 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6216 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6217 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6218 parameter (see below).
6219
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006220 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6221 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6222 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6223 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6224 soft restart.
6225
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006226 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6227
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006228 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6229 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6230 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6231 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6232 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006233 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006234 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6235 if not expiration delay is specified.
6236
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006237 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6238 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6239 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6240 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006241 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6242 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6243 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6244 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6245 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6246 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6247 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6248 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6249 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6250 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6251 types and their arguments.
6252
6253 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6254 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6255 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6256 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6257
6258 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6259 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6260 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6261 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6262
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006263 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6264 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6265 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6266 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6267 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6268 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6269
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006270 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6271 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6272 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6273 they were received.
6274
6275 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6276 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6277 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6278 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6279 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6280
6281 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6282 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6283 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6284 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6285 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6286
6287 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6288 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6289 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6290
6291 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6292 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6293 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6294 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6295 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6296
6297 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6298 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6299 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6300 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6301 the client side.
6302
6303 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6304 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6305 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6306 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6307 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6308 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6309 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6310
6311 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6312 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6313 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6314 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6315 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6316 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6317 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6318
6319 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6320 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6321 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6322 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6323 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6324 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6325
6326 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6327 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6328 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6329 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6330
6331 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6332 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6333 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6334 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6335 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6336 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6337 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6338 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6339 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6340 recommended for better fairness.
6341
6342 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6343 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6344 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6345 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6346
6347 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6348 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6349 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6350 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6351 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6352 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6353 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6354 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6355 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6356 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006357
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006358 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6359 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006360 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6361 reference it.
6362
6363 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6364 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6365 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6366 as an exclusive stickiness.
6367
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006368 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6369 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6370 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6371 something that can be ignored.
6372
6373 Example:
6374 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6375 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6376 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6377 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6378
6379 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006380 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006381
6382
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006383stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6384 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6386 no | no | yes | yes
6387
6388 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006389 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006390 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6391 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6392 server is selected.
6393
6394 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6395 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6396 the "stick-table" statement.
6397
6398 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6399 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6400 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6401 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6402
6403 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6404 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6405 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6406 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6407 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6408 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006409 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006410 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6411 rules.
6412
6413 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6414 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6415 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6416 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6417 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6418 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6419 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6420
6421 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6422 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6423 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6424 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6425
6426 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6427 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6428 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6429 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6430 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6431 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6432 another protocol or access method.
6433
6434 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6435
6436 Example :
6437 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6438 backend https
6439 mode tcp
6440 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006441 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006442 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006443
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006444 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6445 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6446
6447 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6448 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6449 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6450
6451 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6452 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006453
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006454 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6455 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6456 # at offset 44.
6457
6458 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6459 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6460
6461 # Learn on response if server hello.
6462 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006463
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006464 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6465 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6466
6467 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6468 extraction.
6469
6470
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006471tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6472 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6474 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006475 Arguments :
6476 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006477 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6478 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006479
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006480 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006481
6482 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6483 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006484 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6485 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6486 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6487 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6488 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6489 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006490
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006491 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6492 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6493 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6494 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006495
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006496 Three types of actions are supported :
6497 - accept :
6498 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6499 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6500 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006501
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006502 - reject :
6503 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6504 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6505 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6506 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6507 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6508 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6509 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6510 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6511 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6512 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6513 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6514 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006515
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006516 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6517 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6518 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6519 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6520 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6521 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6522 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6523 hosts.
6524
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006525 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006526 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6527 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6528 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006529 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6530 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006531 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006532 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6533 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6534 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6535 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6536 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006537
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006538 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006539 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006540 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006541 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6542 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6543 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6544 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006545
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006546 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6547 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6548 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6549 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006550
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006551 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6552 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6553 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6554 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6555 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006556 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6557 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6558 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6559 layer7 information is extracted.
6560
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006561 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6562 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6563 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6564 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6565 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006567 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6568 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6569 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006571 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6572 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6573 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006574
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006575 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006576 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006577 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006578
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006579 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6580 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6581 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006582
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006583 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006584 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6585 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006586
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006587 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6588
6589 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6590
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006591 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6592
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006593 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006594
6595
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006596tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6597 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006599 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006600 Arguments :
6601 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006602 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6603 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006604 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006605
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006606 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006607
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006608 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6609 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6610 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6611 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6612 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006613
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006614 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6615 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6616 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6617 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6618 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6619 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6620 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6621 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6622 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006623
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006624 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6625 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6626 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6627 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006628
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006629 Three types of actions are supported :
6630 - accept :
6631 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006632 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006633
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006634 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6635 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006636
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006637 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6638 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6639 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006640 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6641 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6642 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6643 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006644 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc0 pointer to track per-frontend
6645 counters and track-sc1 to track per-backend counters, but this is just a
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006646 guideline and all counters may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006648 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006649 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6650 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006651
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006652 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006653 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6654 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6655 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6656 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6657 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006658
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006659 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6660 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6661 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6662 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6663
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006664 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006665 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6666 # and reject everything else.
6667 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6668 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006669 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006670 tcp-request content reject
6671
6672 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006673 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6674 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6675 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006676 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006677
6678 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6679 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6680 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006681 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006682 tcp-request content reject
6683
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006684 Example:
6685 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6686 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006687 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006688
6689 Example:
6690 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6691 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006692 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006693
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006694 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6695 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6696
6697 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006698 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006699 # protecting all our sites
6700 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006701 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6702 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006703 ...
6704 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6705
6706 backend http_dynamic
6707 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006708 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006709 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006710 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6711 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
6712 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006713 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006715 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006716
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006717 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006718
6719
6720tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6721 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006723 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006724 Arguments :
6725 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6726 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6727 as explained at the top of this document.
6728
6729 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6730 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6731 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6732 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6733 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6734
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006735 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6736 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6737 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6738 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6739
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006740 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6741 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006742 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006743 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006744 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6745 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6746 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6747 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006748
6749 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6750 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6751 it pass through unaffected.
6752
6753 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6754 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6755 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006756 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006757 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6758 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006759 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6760 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6761 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006762
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006763 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006764 "timeout client".
6765
6766
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006767tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6768 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6770 no | no | yes | yes
6771 Arguments :
6772 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006773 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006774
6775 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6776
6777 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6778 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6779 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006780 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
6781 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006782
6783 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6784
6785 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6786 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6787 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6788 inserted.
6789
6790 Two types of actions are supported :
6791 - accept :
6792 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6793 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6794 the rules evaluation.
6795
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006796 - close :
6797 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
6798 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
6799 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
6800 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
6801 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
6802 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
6803 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
6804 protocols.
6805
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006806 - reject :
6807 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6808 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006809 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006810
6811 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6812 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6813 for changing the default action to a reject.
6814
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006815 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6816 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6817 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6818 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006819 period.
6820
6821 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6822
6823 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6824
6825
6826tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6827 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6829 no | no | yes | yes
6830 Arguments :
6831 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6833 as explained at the top of this document.
6834
6835 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6836
6837
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006838timeout check <timeout>
6839 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6840 established.
6841
6842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6843 yes | no | yes | yes
6844 Arguments:
6845 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6846 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6847 as explained at the top of this document.
6848
6849 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6850 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6851 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6852 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006853 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6854 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6855 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006856
6857 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6858 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6859
6860 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6861 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006862 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006863
6864 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6865 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6866 forget about it.
6867
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006868 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6869 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006870
6871
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006872timeout client <timeout>
6873timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6874 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6876 yes | yes | yes | no
6877 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006878 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006879 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6880 as explained at the top of this document.
6881
6882 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6883 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6884 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6885 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6886 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6887 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6888 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6889 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006890 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006891 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006892 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6893 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6894 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006895
6896 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6897 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6898 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6899 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6900 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6901 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6902
6903 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6904 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6905 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6906
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006907 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006908
6909
6910timeout connect <timeout>
6911timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6912 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6914 yes | no | yes | yes
6915 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006916 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006917 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6918 as explained at the top of this document.
6919
6920 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006921 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006922 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006923 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006924 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6925 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006926
6927 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6928 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6929 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6930 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6931 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6932 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6933
6934 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6935 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6936 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6937
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006938 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6939 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006940
6941
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006942timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6943 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6945 yes | yes | yes | yes
6946 Arguments :
6947 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6948 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6949 as explained at the top of this document.
6950
6951 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6952 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6953 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6954 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6955 once the request has started to present itself.
6956
6957 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6958 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6959 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6960 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6961 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6962
6963 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6964 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6965 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6966 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6967
6968 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6969 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6970 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6971 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6972 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006973 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006974
6975 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6976 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6977 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6978 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6979
6980 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6981
6982
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006983timeout http-request <timeout>
6984 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006986 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006987 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006988 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006989 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6990 as explained at the top of this document.
6991
6992 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6993 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6994 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6995 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6996 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6997 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6998 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6999 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7000
7001 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7002 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007003 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7004 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007005
7006 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7007 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7008 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7009 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7010 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7011
7012 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007013 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7014 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7015 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007016
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007017 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007018
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007019
7020timeout queue <timeout>
7021 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7023 yes | no | yes | yes
7024 Arguments :
7025 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7026 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7027 as explained at the top of this document.
7028
7029 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7030 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7031 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7032 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7033 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7034
7035 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7036 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7037 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7038 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7039
7040 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7041
7042
7043timeout server <timeout>
7044timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7045 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7047 yes | no | yes | yes
7048 Arguments :
7049 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7050 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7051 as explained at the top of this document.
7052
7053 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7054 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7055 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7056 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7057 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7058 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7059 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7060
7061 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7062 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7063 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7064 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7065 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007066 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007067 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007068 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7069 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7070 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7071 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007072
7073 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7074 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7075 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7076 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7077 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7078 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7079
7080 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7081 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7082 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7083
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007084 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007085
7086
7087timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007088 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7090 yes | yes | yes | yes
7091 Arguments :
7092 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7093 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7094 as explained at the top of this document.
7095
7096 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7097 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7098 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7099
7100 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7101 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7102 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7103 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007104 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007105
7106 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7107
7108
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007109timeout tunnel <timeout>
7110 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7112 yes | no | yes | yes
7113 Arguments :
7114 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7115 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7116 as explained at the top of this document.
7117
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007118 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007119 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7120 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7121 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7122 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7123 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7124 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7125 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7126 specified.
7127
7128 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7129 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7130 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7131 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7132 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7133
7134 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7135 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7136 forget about it.
7137
7138 Example :
7139 defaults http
7140 option http-server-close
7141 timeout connect 5s
7142 timeout client 30s
7143 timeout client 30s
7144 timeout server 30s
7145 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7146
7147 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7148
7149
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007150transparent (deprecated)
7151 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007153 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007154 Arguments : none
7155
7156 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7157 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7158 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7159 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7160 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7161 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7162 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7163 appropriate server.
7164
7165 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7166
7167 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7168 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7169
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007170 See also: "option transparent"
7171
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007172unique-id-format <string>
7173 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7175 yes | yes | yes | no
7176 Arguments :
7177 <string> is a log-format string.
7178
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007179 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7180 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7181 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7182 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007183
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007184 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7185 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7186 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7187 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7188 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7189 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7190 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7191 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007192
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007193 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7194 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007195
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007196 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007197
7198 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7199
7200 will generate:
7201
7202 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7203
7204 See also: "unique-id-header"
7205
7206unique-id-header <name>
7207 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7209 yes | yes | yes | no
7210 Arguments :
7211 <name> is the name of the header.
7212
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007213 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7214 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007215
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007216 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007217
7218 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7219 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7220
7221 will generate:
7222
7223 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7224
7225 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007226
7227use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7228use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007229 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7231 no | yes | yes | no
7232 Arguments :
7233 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007235 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007236
7237 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7238 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7239 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007240 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7241 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7242 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7243 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007244
7245 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7246 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7247 assign the backend.
7248
7249 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7250 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7251 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7252 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7253 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7254 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7255
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007256 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007257 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007258 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7259 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7260 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7261
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007262 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007263
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007264
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007265use-server <server> if <condition>
7266use-server <server> unless <condition>
7267 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7269 no | no | yes | yes
7270 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007271 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007272
7273 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7274
7275 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7276 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7277 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7278
7279 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7280 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7281 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7282 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7283 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7284 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7285 matches will assign the server.
7286
7287 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7288 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7289 with the next rules until one matches.
7290
7291 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7292 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7293 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7294 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7295
7296 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7297 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7298 stripped.
7299
7300 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7301 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7302 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7303 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7304
7305 Example :
7306 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7307 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7308 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7309 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7310 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7311 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7312 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7313 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7314 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7315
7316 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7317
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007318
73195. Bind and Server options
7320--------------------------
7321
7322The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7323depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7324settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7325written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7326described in this section.
7327
7328
73295.1. Bind options
7330-----------------
7331
7332The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7333as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7334no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7335parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7336while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7337provided immediately after the setting name.
7338
7339The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7340
7341accept-proxy
7342 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7343 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7344 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7345 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7346 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7347 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7348 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7349 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7350 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007351 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7352 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007353
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007354alpn <protocols>
7355 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7356 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7357 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7358 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7359 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7360 initial NPN extension.
7361
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007362backlog <backlog>
7363 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7364 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7365
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007366ecdhe <named curve>
7367 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007368 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7369 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007370
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007371ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007372 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7373 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7374 client's certificate.
7375
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007376ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7378 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7379 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7380 error is ignored.
7381
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007382ciphers <ciphers>
7383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7384 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7385 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7386 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7387 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7388
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007389crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007390 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7391 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7392 to verify client's certificate.
7393
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007394crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007395 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7396 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7397 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7398 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7399 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7400 file.
7401
7402 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7403 are loaded.
7404
7405 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7406 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7407 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7408 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7409 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7410 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7411 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7412 www.sub.example.org).
7413
7414 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7415 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7416 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7417 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7418 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7419
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007420 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007421
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007422 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7423 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7424 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7425 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7426 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7427 clients).
7428
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007429crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007430 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7431 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7432 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7433 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007434
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007435crt-list <file>
7436 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007437 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7438 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007439
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007440 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007441
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007442 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7443 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7444 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7445 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7446 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7447 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7448 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7449 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007450
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007451defer-accept
7452 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7453 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7454 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7455 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7456 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7457 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7458 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7459 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7460 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7461 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7462 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7463
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007464force-sslv3
7465 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7466 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7467 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7468
7469force-tlsv10
7470 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7471 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7472
7473force-tlsv11
7474 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7475 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7476
7477force-tlsv12
7478 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7479 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7480
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007481gid <gid>
7482 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7483 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7484 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7485 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7486 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7487
7488group <group>
7489 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7490 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7491 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7492 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7493 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7494
7495id <id>
7496 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7497 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7498 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7499 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7500
7501interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007502 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7503 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7504 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7505 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7506 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7507 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7508 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007509
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007510level <level>
7511 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7512 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7513 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7514 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7515 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7516 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7517 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7518 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7519 counters).
7520 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7521 all counters).
7522
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007523maxconn <maxconn>
7524 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7525 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7526 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7527 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7528 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7529 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7530 eat all memory.
7531
7532mode <mode>
7533 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7534 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7535 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7536 UNIX sockets.
7537
7538mss <maxseg>
7539 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7540 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7541 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7542 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7543 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7544 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7545 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7546 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7547 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7548 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7549 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7550
7551name <name>
7552 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7553 page.
7554
7555nice <nice>
7556 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7557 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7558 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7559 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7560 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7561 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7562 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7563 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7564 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7565 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7566 one for an RDP socket.
7567
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007568no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007569 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7570 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7571 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007572 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7573 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007574
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007575no-tls-tickets
7576 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7577 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7578 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7579 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7580
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007581no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007583 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7584 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7585 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7586 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007587
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007588no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007589 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007590 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7591 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7592 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7593 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007594
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007595no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007597 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7598 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7599 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7600 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007601
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007602npn <protocols>
7603 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7604 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7605 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7606 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007607 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7608 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007609
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007610ssl
7611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7612 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7613 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7614 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7615 to deciphered contents.
7616
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007617strict-sni
7618 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7619 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7620 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7621 See the "crt" option for more information.
7622
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007623tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007624 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007625 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7626 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7627 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7628 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7629 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7630 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7631 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007632 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7633 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7634 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007635
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007636transparent
7637 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7638 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7639 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7640 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7641 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7642 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7643 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7644 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7645 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7646 so check for support with your vendor.
7647
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007648v4v6
7649 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7650 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7651 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7652 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7653 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7654
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007655v6only
7656 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7657 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7658 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007659 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7660 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007661
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007662uid <uid>
7663 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7664 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7665 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7666 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7667 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7668
7669user <user>
7670 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7671 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7672 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7673 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7674 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7675
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007676verify [none|optional|required]
7677 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7678 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7679 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7680 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7681 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007682 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7683 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7684 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7685 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007686
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020076875.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007688------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007690The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7691which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7692arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7693settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7694after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7695Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7696address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007698 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007699 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007700
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007701The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007702
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007703addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007704 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7705 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7706 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7707 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7708 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007710 Supported in default-server: No
7711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007712backup
7713 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7714 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7715 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7716 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7717 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7718 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007720 Supported in default-server: No
7721
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007722ca-file <cafile>
7723 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7724 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7725 server's certificate.
7726
7727 Supported in default-server: No
7728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007729check
7730 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007731 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7732 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7733 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7734 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7735 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7736 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7737 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09007738 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the
7739 "httpchk", "lb-agent-chk", "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and
7740 "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and parameters for
7741 more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007743 Supported in default-server: No
7744
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007745check-send-proxy
7746 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7747 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7748 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7749 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7750 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7751 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7752 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7753
7754 Supported in default-server: No
7755
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007756check-ssl
7757 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7758 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7759 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7760 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7761 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7762 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7763 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7764 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7765 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7766
7767 Supported in default-server: No
7768
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007769ciphers <ciphers>
7770 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7771 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7772 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7773 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7774 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7775 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7776 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7777 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7778
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007779 Supported in default-server: No
7780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007781cookie <value>
7782 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7783 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7784 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7785 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7786 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7787 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7788 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007790 Supported in default-server: No
7791
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007792crl-file <crlfile>
7793 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7794 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7795 to verify server's certificate.
7796
7797 Supported in default-server: No
7798
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007799crt <cert>
7800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7801 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7802 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7803 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7804 certificate request.
7805
7806 Supported in default-server: No
7807
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007808disabled
7809 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7810 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7811 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7812 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7813 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7814
7815 Supported in default-server: No
7816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007817error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007818 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7819 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7820 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007822 Supported in default-server: Yes
7823
7824 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007826fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007827 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7828 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7829 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7830
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007831 Supported in default-server: Yes
7832
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007833force-sslv3
7834 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7835 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7836 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7837
7838 Supported in default-server: No
7839
7840force-tlsv10
7841 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7842 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7843
7844 Supported in default-server: No
7845
7846force-tlsv11
7847 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7848 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7849
7850 Supported in default-server: No
7851
7852force-tlsv12
7853 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7854 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7855
7856 Supported in default-server: No
7857
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007858id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007859 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7860 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7861 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007863 Supported in default-server: No
7864
7865inter <delay>
7866fastinter <delay>
7867downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007868 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7869 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7870 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7871 between checks depending on the server state :
7872
7873 Server state | Interval used
7874 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7875 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7876 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7877 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7878 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7879 or yet unchecked. |
7880 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7881 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7882 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007884 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7885 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7886 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7887 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7888 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7889 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7890 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7891 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7892 servers.
7893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007894 Supported in default-server: Yes
7895
7896maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007897 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7898 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7899 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7900 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7901 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7902 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7903 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7904 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007906 Supported in default-server: Yes
7907
7908maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007909 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7910 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7911 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7912 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7913 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7914 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7915 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7916
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007917 Supported in default-server: Yes
7918
7919minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007920 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7921 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7922 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7923 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7924 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7925 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007926 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007927 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007928
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007929 Supported in default-server: Yes
7930
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007931no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007932 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7933 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007934 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007935
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007936 Supported in default-server: No
7937
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007938no-tls-tickets
7939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7940 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7941 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7942 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7943
7944 Supported in default-server: No
7945
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007946no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007947 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007948 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7949 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007950 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7951 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007952
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007953 Supported in default-server: No
7954
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007955no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007956 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007957 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7958 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007959 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7960 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007961
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007962 Supported in default-server: No
7963
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007964no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007965 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007966 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7967 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007968 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7969 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007970
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007971 Supported in default-server: No
7972
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007973non-stick
7974 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7975 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7976 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7977
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007978 Supported in default-server: No
7979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007980observe <mode>
7981 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7982 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7983 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7984 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7985 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7986 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007987 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007989 Supported in default-server: No
7990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007991 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007993on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007994 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7995 Currently, four modes are available:
7996 - fastinter: force fastinter
7997 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7998 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7999 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8000 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008002 Supported in default-server: Yes
8003
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008004 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8005
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008006on-marked-down <action>
8007 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8008 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008009 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8010 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8011 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8012 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8013 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8014 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8015 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8016 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008017
8018 Actions are disabled by default
8019
8020 Supported in default-server: Yes
8021
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008022on-marked-up <action>
8023 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8024 Currently one action is available:
8025 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8026 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8027 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8028 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8029 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8030 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8031 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8032 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8033
8034 Actions are disabled by default
8035
8036 Supported in default-server: Yes
8037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008038port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008039 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8040 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8041 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8042 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8043 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8044 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8045
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008046 Supported in default-server: Yes
8047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008048redir <prefix>
8049 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8050 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8051 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8052 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8053 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8054 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8055 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8056 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008057 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008058 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8059 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8060 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8061 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8062 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8063
8064 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8065
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008066 Supported in default-server: No
8067
8068rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008069 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8070 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8071 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8072
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008073 Supported in default-server: Yes
8074
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008075send-proxy
8076 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8077 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8078 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8079 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8080 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8081 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8082 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8083 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8084 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008085 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8086 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8087 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8088 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8089 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008090
8091 Supported in default-server: No
8092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008093slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008094 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8095 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8096 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8097 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8098 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8099 parameters :
8100
8101 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8102 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8103
8104 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8105 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8106 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8107 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8108
8109 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8110 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8111 seen as failed.
8112
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008113 Supported in default-server: Yes
8114
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008115source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008116source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008117source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008118 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8119 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8120 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8121 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8122
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008123 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8124 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8125 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8126 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8127 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8128 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8129 server.
8130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008131 Supported in default-server: No
8132
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008133ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008134 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8135 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8136 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8137 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8138 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8139 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8140 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008141
8142 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008144track [<proxy>/]<server>
8145 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8146 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8147 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8148 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8149 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008151 Supported in default-server: No
8152
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008153verify [none|required]
8154 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8155 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
8156 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
8157 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008158 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8159 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8160 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008161
8162 Supported in default-server: No
8163
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008164verifyhost <hostname>
8165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8166 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8167 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8168 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8169 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8170 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8171
8172 Supported in default-server: No
8173
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008174weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008175 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8176 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8177 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008178 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8179 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8180 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8181 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8182 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8183 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008184
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008185 Supported in default-server: Yes
8186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008187
81886. HTTP header manipulation
8189---------------------------
8190
8191In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8192response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8193request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8194which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8195against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8196to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8197passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8198headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8199never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8200
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008201There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8202(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8203rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8204messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8205in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008206happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008207add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8208normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008210This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8211in section 4.2 :
8212
8213 - reqadd <string>
8214 - reqallow <search>
8215 - reqiallow <search>
8216 - reqdel <search>
8217 - reqidel <search>
8218 - reqdeny <search>
8219 - reqideny <search>
8220 - reqpass <search>
8221 - reqipass <search>
8222 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8223 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8224 - reqtarpit <search>
8225 - reqitarpit <search>
8226 - rspadd <string>
8227 - rspdel <search>
8228 - rspidel <search>
8229 - rspdeny <search>
8230 - rspideny <search>
8231 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8232 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8233
8234With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8235is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8236parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8237prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8238Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8239
8240 \t for a tab
8241 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8242 \n for a new line (LF)
8243 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8244 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8245 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8246 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8247 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8248
8249The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8250portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8251above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8252regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
82539 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8254is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8255
8256The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8257after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8258
8259Notes related to these keywords :
8260---------------------------------
8261 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8262 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8263 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8264
8265 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8266 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8267 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8268
8269 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8270 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8271 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8272 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8273 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8274
8275 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8276 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8277 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8278 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8279 useless headers before adding new ones.
8280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008281 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008282 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8283
8284 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8285 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8286 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8287
8288 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8289 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008290 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008291
8292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020082937. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8294----------------------------------
8295
8296Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8297client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8298The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8299these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8300but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8301data called patterns.
8302
8303
83047.1. ACL basics
8305---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008306
8307The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8308content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8309from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8310simple :
8311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008312 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
8313 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8314 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008316The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8317adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008318
8319In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008321 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008322
8323This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8324Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8325and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
8326an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
8327of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
8328
8329ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8330'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8331which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8332
8333There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8334performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008336The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8337specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8338this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
8339methods of a same sample fetch method.
8340
8341Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8342 - boolean
8343 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8344 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8345 - string
8346 - data block
8347
8348The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8349 - boolean
8350 - integer or integer range
8351 - IP address / network
8352 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8353 - regular expression
8354 - hex block
8355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008356The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8357
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008358 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8359 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008360 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008361 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008363The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8364read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8365if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8366lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8367will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8368beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8369a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8370lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8371exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8372
8373Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8374loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8375
8376 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8377
8378In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8379the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8380case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8381as well.
8382
8383The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8384sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8385do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8386methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8387is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8388obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8389followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8390default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8391that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8392string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8393
8394There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8395sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8396be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008397
8398 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8399 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008400 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8401 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8402 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8403 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008404
8405 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8406 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008407 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008408
8409 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008410 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008411
8412 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008413 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008414
8415 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8416 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8417
8418 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8419 binary or string samples.
8420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008421 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8422 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008424 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8425 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8426 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008428 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8429 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008431 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8432 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008434 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8435 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008437 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8438 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008439 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008441 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8442 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8443 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008444
8445For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8446request, it is possible to do :
8447
8448 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8449
8450In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8451buffer, one would use the following acl :
8452
8453 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008455All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8456criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8457method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8458to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8459criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8460the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008462If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8463the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8464example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008466 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8467 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8468 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8469 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008470
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008472The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample fetch types
8473and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8474combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8475the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008477 +-------------------------------------------------+
8478 | Input sample type |
8479 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8480 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8481 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8482 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8483 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8484 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | | |
8485 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8486 | integer (value) | int | *int | | | |
8487 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8488 | integer (length) | | | | len | len |
8489 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8490 | IP address | | | *ip | | |
8491 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8492 | exact string | | | | str | str |
8493 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8494 | prefix | | | | beg | beg |
8495 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8496 | suffix | | | | end | end |
8497 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8498 | substring | | | | sub | sub |
8499 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8500 | subdir | | | | dir | dir |
8501 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8502 | domain | | | | dom | dom |
8503 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8504 | regex | | | | reg | reg |
8505 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8506 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8507 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008508
8509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085107.1.1. Matching booleans
8511------------------------
8512
8513In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8514Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8515When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8516that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8517
8518Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8519return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8520"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8521
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085237.1.2. Matching integers
8524------------------------
8525
8526Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8527enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8528to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8529
8530Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8531matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8532lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008533
8534For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8535unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8536representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8537
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008538As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8539two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8540instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8541ranges and operators.
8542
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008543For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008544operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8545Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8546of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008547
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008548Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008549
8550 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8551 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8552 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8553 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8554 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008556For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008557
8558 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8559
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008560This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8561
8562 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085657.1.3. Matching strings
8566-----------------------
8567
8568String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8569different forms :
8570
8571 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8572 patterns ;
8573
8574 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8575 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8576
8577 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8578 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8579
8580 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8581 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8582
8583 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8584 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
8585 matches.
8586
8587 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8588 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
8589 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008590
8591String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8592exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8593characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8594string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8595to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008596before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008597
8598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085997.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8600---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008601
8602Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8603they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8604possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8605passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8606the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008607the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8608match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008609
8610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020086117.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
8612-------------------------------------
8613
8614It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
8615not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
8616a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
8617to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
8618digits may be used upper or lower case.
8619
8620Example :
8621 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
8622 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
8623
8624
86257.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
8626---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008627
8628IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8629netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8630within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008631host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008632difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8633at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8634does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8635parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008636
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008637IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8638Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8639trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8640IPv6 patterns.
8641
8642HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8643following situations :
8644 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8645 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8646 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8647 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8648 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8649 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8650 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8651 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8652 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8653 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008655
86567.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
8657----------------------------------
8658
8659Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8660combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
8661
8662 - AND (implicit)
8663 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8664 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008666A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008668 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008670Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8671indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008673For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8674"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8675requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8676is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
8677
8678 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8679 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8680 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8681 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
8682
8683To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8684and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
8685
8686 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8687 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8688 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8689 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
8690
8691 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8692 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8693 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8694 use_backend www if host_www
8695
8696It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8697expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8698be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8699the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
8700
8701 The following rule :
8702
8703 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8704 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8705
8706 Can also be written that way :
8707
8708 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8709
8710It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8711to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8712simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8713sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8714good use is the following :
8715
8716 With named ACLs :
8717
8718 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8719 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8720 monitor fail if site_dead
8721
8722 With anonymous ACLs :
8723
8724 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8725
8726See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
8727
8728
87297.3. Fetching samples
8730---------------------
8731
8732Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
8733against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
8734sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
8735ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
8736of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
8737available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
8738
8739This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
8740Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
8741compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
8742deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
8743
8744The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
8745matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
8746method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
8747indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
8748
8749As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
8750when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
8751mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
8752the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
8753ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
8754
8755Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
8756multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
8757when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
8758incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
8759are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
8760is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
8761all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
8762
8763Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
8764 - name
8765 - name(arg1)
8766 - name(arg1,arg2)
8767
8768At the moment, the stickiness features are the most advanced users of the
8769sample fetch system. The "stick on", and "stick store-request" directives
8770support sample fetch rules which allow a list of transformations to be applied
8771on top of the fetched sample, and the finaly result is automatically converted
8772to the type of the table. These transformations are enumerated as a series
Willy Tarreau833cc792013-07-24 15:34:19 +02008773of specific keywords after the sample fetch method. These keywords may equally
8774be appended immediately after the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a
8775comma. These keywords can also support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which
8776must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008778The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008780 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
8781 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
8782 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008784 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
8785 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
8786 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008788 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
8789 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
8790 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8791 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8792 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8793
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02008794 http_date([<offset>])
8795 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
8796 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
8797 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
8798 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
8799 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
8800 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
8801 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
8802 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008803
88047.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
8805--------------------------------------------
8806
8807A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
8808not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
8809"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
8810The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
8811
8812always_false : boolean
8813 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
8814 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8815
8816always_true : boolean
8817 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
8818 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8819
8820avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008821 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008822 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
8823 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
8824 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
8825 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
8826 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
8827 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
8828 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
8829 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
8830 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
8831 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
8832 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
8833 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
8834 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01008835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008836be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008837 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
8838 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
8839 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8840 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8841 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008843be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
8844 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8845 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
8846 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
8847 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
8848 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
8849 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008850
8851 Example :
8852 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8853 backend dynamic
8854 mode http
8855 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8856 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008858connslots([<backend>]) : integer
8859 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
8860 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
8861 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
8862 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05008863
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008864 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008865 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008866 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8867
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008868 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8869 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008870
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008871 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008872 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008873 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008874 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8875 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008876 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008877 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008878
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008879 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8880 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008881 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008882 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008883
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02008884date([<offset>]) : integer
8885 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
8886 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
8887 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
8888 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02008889 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
8890
8891 Example :
8892
8893 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
8894 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02008895
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02008896env(<name>) : string
8897 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
8898 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
8899 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
8900 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
8901 certain way.
8902
8903 Examples :
8904 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
8905 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
8906
8907 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
8908 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
8909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008910fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
8911 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008912 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8913 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008914 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
8915 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
8916 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
8917 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
8918 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008920fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
8921 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8922 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
8923 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
8924 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
8925 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
8926 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
8927 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
8928 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008929
8930 Example :
8931 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8932 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8933 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8934 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8935 frontend mail
8936 bind :25
8937 mode tcp
8938 maxconn 100
8939 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8940 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8941 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8942 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008944nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
8945 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
8946 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
8947 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008948 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8949 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8950 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008952queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008953 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8954 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8955 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008956 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
8957 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
8958 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
8959 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
8960 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
8961
8962srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
8963 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
8964 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
8965 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
8966 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
8967 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
8968 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
8969 methods.
8970
8971srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
8972 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8973 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8974 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
8975 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
8976 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
8977 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
8978 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8979
8980srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
8981 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8982 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
8983 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
8984 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
8985 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
8986 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
8987 overloading servers).
8988
8989 Example :
8990 # Redirect to a separate back
8991 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
8992 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
8993 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
8994
8995table_avl([<table>]) : integer
8996 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8997 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8998
8999table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9000 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9001 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9002 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9003
9004
90057.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9006----------------------------------
9007
9008The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9009closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9010methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9011sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9012TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009013the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9014counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9015"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009016argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9017the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9018this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009019
9020be_id : integer
9021 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9022 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9023
9024dst : ip
9025 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9026 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9027 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9028 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9029 RFC 4291.
9030
9031dst_conn : integer
9032 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9033 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9034 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9035 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9036 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9037 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9038 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9039 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009041dst_port : integer
9042 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9043 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9044 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9045 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9046 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9047 an HTTP header.
9048
9049fe_id : integer
9050 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9051 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9052 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9053
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009054sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9055sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9056sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9057sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009058 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9059 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9060 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9061
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009062sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9063sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9064sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9065sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009066 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9067 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9068 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9069
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009070sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9071sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9072sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9073sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009074 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9075 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009076 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9077 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9078 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009079
9080 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9081 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009082 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9083 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9084 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009085 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9086 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9087
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009088sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9089sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9090sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9091sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009092 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9093 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9094
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009095sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9096sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9097sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9098sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009099 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9100 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9101 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9102
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009103sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9104sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9105sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9106sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009107 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9108 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9109 See also src_conn_rate.
9110
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009111sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9112sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9113sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9114sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009115 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009116 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009117
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009118sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9119sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9120sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9121sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009122 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9123 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9124 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009125 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9126 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9127 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009128
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009129sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9130sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9131sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9132sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009133 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9134 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9135 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9136
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009137sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9138sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9139sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9140sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009141 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9142 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9143 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9144 src_http_err_rate.
9145
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009146sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9147sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9148sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9149sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009150 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9151 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9152 src_http_req_cnt.
9153
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009154sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9155sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9156sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9157sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009158 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9159 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9160 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9161 src_http_req_rate.
9162
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009163sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9164sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9165sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9166sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009167 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009168 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9169 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9170 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9171 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009172
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009173 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9174 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009175 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9176
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009177sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9178sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9179sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9180sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009181 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9182 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9183 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9184 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9185
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009186sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9187sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9188sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9189sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009190 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9191 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9192 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9193 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9194
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009195sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9196sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9197sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9198sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009199 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9200 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9201 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9202 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009203 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009204 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9205
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009206sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9207sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9208sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9209sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009210 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9211 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9212 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9213 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9214 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009215 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009216
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009217sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9218sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9219sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9220sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009221 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9222 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9223 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9224
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009225sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9226sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9227sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9228sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009229 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9230 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009231 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009232 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9233 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009234 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9235 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9236 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009238so_id : integer
9239 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9240 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9241 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009243src : ip
9244 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9245 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9246 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9247 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9248 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9249 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9250 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009252src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9253 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9254 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9255 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009256 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009258src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9259 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9260 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009261 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009262 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009264src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9265 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9266 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9267 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9268 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9269 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9270 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009271
9272 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9273 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9274 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9275 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009276 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009277 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9278 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009280src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009281 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009282 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009283 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009284 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009286src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009287 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009288 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9289 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009290 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009292src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9293 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9294 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9295 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009296 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009298src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009299 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009300 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009301 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009302 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009304src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009305 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009306 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009307 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9308 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009309 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9310 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9311 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009313src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9314 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9315 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009316 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009317 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009318 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009320src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9321 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9322 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9323 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9324 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009325 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009327src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9328 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9329 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9330 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009331 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009333src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9334 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9335 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9336 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009337 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009338 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009340src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9341 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9342 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9343 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009344 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009345 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9346 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009347
9348 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009349 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009350 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009352src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9353 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9354 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9355 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9356 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009357 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9358 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009360src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9361 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9362 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009363 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9364 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009365 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009367src_port : integer
9368 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9369 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9370 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9371 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009373src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9374 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009375 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9376 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9377 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009378 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009380src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9381 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9382 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9383 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9384 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009385 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009387src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9388 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9389 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9390 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9391 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9392 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9393 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9394 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9395 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009396
9397 Example :
9398 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9399 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9400 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9401 listen ssh
9402 bind :22
9403 mode tcp
9404 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009405 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009406 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009407 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009409srv_id : integer
9410 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9411 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9412 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009413
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094157.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9416----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009418The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9419closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9420when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9421usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9422future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009424ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9425 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9426 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9427 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9428 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9429 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009431ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9432 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9433 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9434 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9435 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009437ssl_c_err : integer
9438 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9439 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9440 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9441 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9442 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009444ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9445 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9446 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9447 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9448 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9449 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9450 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9451 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9452 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009454 ACL derivatives :
9455 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009457ssl_c_key_alg : string
9458 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9459 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9460 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009462 ACL derivatives :
9463 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009465ssl_c_notafter : string
9466 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9467 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9468 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009470 ACL derivatives :
9471 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009473ssl_c_notbefore : string
9474 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9475 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9476 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009478 ACL derivatives :
9479 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009481ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9482 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9483 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9484 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9485 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9486 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9487 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9488 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9489 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009491 ACL derivatives :
9492 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009494ssl_c_serial : binary
9495 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9496 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9497 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009499 ACL derivatives :
9500 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009502ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9503 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9504 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9505 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009507ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9508 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9509 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9510 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009512 ACL derivatives :
9513 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9514
9515ssl_c_used : boolean
9516 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9517 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009519ssl_c_verify : integer
9520 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9521 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9522 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
9523 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009525ssl_c_version : integer
9526 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
9527 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009529ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9530 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9531 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9532 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9533 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009534 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009535 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9536 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9537 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009539 ACL derivatives :
9540 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009542ssl_f_key_alg : string
9543 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9544 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
9545 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009547 ACL derivatives :
9548 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009550ssl_f_notafter : string
9551 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9552 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9553 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009555 ACL derivatives :
9556 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009558ssl_f_notbefore : string
9559 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9560 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9561 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009563 ACL derivatives :
9564 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009566ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9567 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9568 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9569 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9570 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9571 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9572 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9573 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9574 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009576 ACL derivatives :
9577 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009579ssl_f_serial : binary
9580 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9581 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9582 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009584 ACL derivatives :
9585 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009587ssl_f_sig_alg : string
9588 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9589 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9590 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009592 ACL derivatives :
9593 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009595ssl_f_version : integer
9596 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9597 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9598
9599ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009600 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9601 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
9602 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
9603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009604 Example :
9605 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
9606 listen http-https
9607 bind :80
9608 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
9609 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
9610
9611ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
9612 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
9613 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9614
9615ssl_fc_alpn : string
9616 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
9617 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
9618 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
9619 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
9620 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
9621 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
9622 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
9623 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
9624 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
9625
9626 ACL derivatives :
9627 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009629ssl_fc_cipher : string
9630 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
9631 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009633 ACL derivatives :
9634 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009636ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009637 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
9638 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009639 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
9640 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
9641 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
9642 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009644ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
9645 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009646 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
9647 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
9648 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9649 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009651ssl_fc_npn : string
9652 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
9653 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
9654 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
9655 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9656 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
9657 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
9658 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
9659 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009661 ACL derivatives :
9662 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009664ssl_fc_protocol : string
9665 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
9666 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009668 ACL derivatives :
9669 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
9670
9671ssl_fc_session_id : binary
9672 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
9673 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
9674 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
9675 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009677ssl_fc_sni : string
9678 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
9679 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9680 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
9681 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
9682 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
9683
9684 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
9685 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
9686 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02009687 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
9688 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009690 ACL derivatives :
9691 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
9692 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
9693 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009695ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
9696 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
9697 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009698
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097007.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
9701------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009703Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
9704sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
9705only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
9706For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
9707be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
9708can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
9709sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
9710for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
9711content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009713payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
9714 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
9715 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
9716 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009718payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
9719 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
9720 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
9721 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009723req.len : integer
9724req_len : integer (deprecated)
9725 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
9726 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
9727 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
9728 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
9729 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
9730 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
9731 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
9732 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009734req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
9735 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +02009736 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
9737 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
9738 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
9739 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009741 ACL alternatives :
9742 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009744req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
9745 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9746 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9747 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9748 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009750 ACL alternatives :
9751 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009753 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009755req.proto_http : boolean
9756req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
9757 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
9758 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
9759 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
9760 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
9761 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
9762 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
9763 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009765 Example:
9766 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9767 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
9768 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009769 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009771req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
9772rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9773 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
9774 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
9775 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
9776 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
9777 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
9778 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
9779 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009781 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
9782 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
9783 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9784 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
9785 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
9786 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009788 ACL derivatives :
9789 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009791 Example :
9792 listen tse-farm
9793 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9794 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9795 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9796 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9797 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9798 persist rdp-cookie
9799 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9800 # This is only useful makes sense if
9801 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9802 stick-table type string size 204800
9803 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9804 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9805 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009807 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
9808 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009810req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
9811rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
9812 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
9813 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
9814 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
9815 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009817 ACL derivatives :
9818 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009820req.ssl_hello_type : integer
9821req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
9822 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
9823 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
9824 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
9825 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
9826 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
9827 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
9828 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009830req.ssl_sni : string
9831req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
9832 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
9833 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
9834 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
9835 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
9836 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
9837 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
9838 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
9839 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
9840 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
9841 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
9842 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
9843 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009845 ACL derivatives :
9846 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009848 Examples :
9849 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
9850 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9851 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
9852 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
9853 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009855res.ssl_hello_type : integer
9856rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
9857 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
9858 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
9859 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
9860 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
9861 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
9862 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
9863 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02009864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009865req.ssl_ver : integer
9866req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
9867 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
9868 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
9869 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
9870 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
9871 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
9872 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
9873 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
9874 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
9875 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009877 ACL derivatives :
9878 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009879
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +02009880res.len : integer
9881 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
9882 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
9883 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
9884 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
9885 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
9886 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
9887 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
9888 content inspection.
9889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009890res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
9891 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +02009892 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
9893 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
9894 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
9895 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009897res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
9898 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9899 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9900 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
9901 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009903 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009905wait_end : boolean
9906 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
9907 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
9908 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
9909 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
9910 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
9911 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
9912 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
9913 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009915 Examples :
9916 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
9917 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
9918 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009920 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
9921 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
9922 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
9923 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
9924 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
9925 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
9926 tcp-request content reject
9927
9928
99297.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
9930--------------------------------------
9931
9932It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
9933This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
9934data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
9935its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
9936HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
9937content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
9938to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
9939more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
9940response are indexed.
9941
9942base : string
9943 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
9944 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
9945 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
9946 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
9947 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9948 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
9949 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
9950 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
9951
9952 ACL derivatives :
9953 base : exact string match
9954 base_beg : prefix match
9955 base_dir : subdir match
9956 base_dom : domain match
9957 base_end : suffix match
9958 base_len : length match
9959 base_reg : regex match
9960 base_sub : substring match
9961
9962base32 : integer
9963 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
9964 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
9965 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
9966 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
9967
9968base32+src : binary
9969 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
9970 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
9971 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
9972 per-URL counters.
9973
9974req.cook([<name>]) : string
9975cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9976 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
9977 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
9978 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
9979 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
9980 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
9981 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
9982 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
9983 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9984
9985 ACL derivatives :
9986 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
9987 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
9988 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
9989 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
9990 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
9991 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
9992 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
9993 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009995req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
9996cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
9997 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
9998 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010000req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10001cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10002 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10003 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10004 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10005 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010007cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10008 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10009 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10010 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10011 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10012 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10013 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10014 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10015 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10016 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10017 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010019hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10020 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10021 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10022 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10023 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
10024 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010026req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10027 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10028 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10029 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10030 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10031 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10032 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10033 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10034 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010036req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10037 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10038 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10039 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10040 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010042req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10043 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10044 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10045 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10046 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10047 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10048 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10049 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10050 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10051 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10052 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10053 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010055 ACL derivatives :
10056 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10057 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10058 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10059 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10060 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10061 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10062 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10063 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10064
10065req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10066hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10067 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10068 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10069 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10070 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10071 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10072 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10073 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10074 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10075 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10076
10077req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10078hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10079 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10080 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10081 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10082 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10083 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10084 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10085 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10086 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10087
10088req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10089hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10090 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10091 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10092 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10093 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10094 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10095 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10096 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10097
10098http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10099 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10100 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10101 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10102 basic auth is supported.
10103
10104http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10105 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10106 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10107 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10108 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10109 basic auth is supported.
10110
10111 ACL derivatives :
10112 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10113
10114http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010115 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10116 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010117 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10118 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010120method : integer + string
10121 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10122 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10123 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10124 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10125 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10126 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10127 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010129 ACL derivatives :
10130 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010132 Example :
10133 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10134 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10135 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010137path : string
10138 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10139 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10140 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10141 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10142 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10143 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10144 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010146 ACL derivatives :
10147 path : exact string match
10148 path_beg : prefix match
10149 path_dir : subdir match
10150 path_dom : domain match
10151 path_end : suffix match
10152 path_len : length match
10153 path_reg : regex match
10154 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010156req.ver : string
10157req_ver : string (deprecated)
10158 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10159 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10160 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010162 ACL derivatives :
10163 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010165res.comp : boolean
10166 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10167 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10168 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010170res.comp_algo : string
10171 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10172 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10173 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010175res.cook([<name>]) : string
10176scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10177 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10178 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10179 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010181 ACL derivatives :
10182 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010184res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10185scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10186 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10187 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10188 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010190res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10191scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10192 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10193 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10194 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010196res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10197 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10198 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10199 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10200 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10201 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10202 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10203 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10204 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10205 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010207res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10208 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10209 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10210 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10211 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10212 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010214res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10215shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10216 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10217 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10218 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10219 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10220 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10221 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10222 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10223 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010225 ACL derivatives :
10226 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10227 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10228 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10229 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10230 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10231 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10232 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10233 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10234
10235res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10236shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10237 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10238 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10239 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10240 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10241 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010243res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10244shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10245 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10246 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10247 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10248 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10249 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10250 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010252res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10253shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10254 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10255 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10256 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10257 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10258 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10259 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010261res.ver : string
10262resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10263 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10264 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010266 ACL derivatives :
10267 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010269set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10270 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10271 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10272 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10273 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010275 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10276 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010278 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010280status : integer
10281 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10282 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10283 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010285url : string
10286 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10287 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10288 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10289 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10290 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10291 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10292 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010294 ACL derivatives :
10295 url : exact string match
10296 url_beg : prefix match
10297 url_dir : subdir match
10298 url_dom : domain match
10299 url_end : suffix match
10300 url_len : length match
10301 url_reg : regex match
10302 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010304url_ip : ip
10305 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10306 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10307 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10308 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10309 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10310 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10311 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010313url_port : integer
10314 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10315 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10316 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10317 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010319urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10320url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10321 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10322 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10323 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10324 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10325 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10326 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10327 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10328 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10329 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010331 ACL derivatives :
10332 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10333 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10334 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10335 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10336 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10337 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10338 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10339 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010340
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010342 Example :
10343 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10344 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10345 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10346 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010348urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10349 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10350 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10351 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010352
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103547.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010355---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010356
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010357Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10358every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010359order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010361ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10362---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010363FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010364HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010365HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10366HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010367HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10368HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10369HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10370HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10371LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010372METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10373METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10374METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10375METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10376METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10377METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010378RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010379REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010380TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010381WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10382---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010383
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103858. Logging
10386----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010387
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010388One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10389provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10390very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10391provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10392state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010393to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010394headers.
10395
10396In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10397about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10398send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10399
10400 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10401 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10402 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10403 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10404 at the termination.
10405
10406The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10407allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10408as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10409while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10410real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10411delay.
10412
10413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104148.1. Log levels
10415---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010416
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010417TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010418source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010419HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10420in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10421track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10422syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10423about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010424
10425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104268.2. Log formats
10427----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010428
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010429HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010430and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10431slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10432options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010433
10434 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10435 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10436 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10437 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10438 extents.
10439
10440 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10441 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10442 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10443 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10444 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10445
10446 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10447 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10448 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10449 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10450 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10451
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010452 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10453 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10454 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10455 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10456
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010457 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10458
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010459Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10460specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10461field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10462servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10463always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10464identifier.
10465
10466Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10467 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10468 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10469 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10470 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10471
10472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104738.2.1. Default log format
10474-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010475
10476This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10477as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10478format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10479
10480 Example :
10481 listen www
10482 mode http
10483 log global
10484 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10485
10486 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10487 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10488 (www/HTTP)
10489
10490 Field Format Extract from the example above
10491 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10492 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10493 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10494 4 'to' to
10495 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10496 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10497
10498Detailed fields description :
10499 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10500 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10501 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10502 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10503 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10504 and processed the connection.
10505 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10506
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010507In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10508"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10509connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10510
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010511It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10512will eventually disappear.
10513
10514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105158.2.2. TCP log format
10516---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010517
10518The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
10519is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
10520information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
10521counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
10522emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
10523environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
10524the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
10525sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010526specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
10527not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
10528fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
10529marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010530
10531 Example :
10532 frontend fnt
10533 mode tcp
10534 option tcplog
10535 log global
10536 default_backend bck
10537
10538 backend bck
10539 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10540
10541 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
10542 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
10543 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
10544
10545 Field Format Extract from the example above
10546 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
10547 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
10548 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
10549 4 frontend_name fnt
10550 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
10551 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
10552 7 bytes_read* 212
10553 8 termination_state --
10554 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
10555 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10556
10557Detailed fields description :
10558 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010559 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10560 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10561 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10562 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10563 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010564
10565 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010566 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10567 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10568 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010569
10570 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
10571 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
10572 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
10573 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
10574
10575 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10576 and processed the connection.
10577
10578 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10579 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10580 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
10581 applications.
10582
10583 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10584 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10585 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10586 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
10587 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
10588
10589 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10590 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10591 See "Timers" below for more details.
10592
10593 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10594 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10595 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
10596 "Timers" below for more details.
10597
10598 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10599 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10600 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10601 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10602 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10603 details.
10604
10605 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
10606 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
10607 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
10608 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
10609 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
10610
10611 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10612 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10613 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
10614 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
10615 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
10616 for more details.
10617
10618 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010619 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010620 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
10621 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
10622 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010623 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010624
10625 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10626 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10627 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10628 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10629 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10630 caused by a denial of service attack.
10631
10632 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10633 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10634 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10635 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10636 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10637 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10638 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10639 denial of service attack.
10640
10641 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10642 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10643 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10644 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10645 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10646 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10647 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10648 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
10649 be processed than on other servers.
10650
10651 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10652 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10653 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10654 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10655 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10656 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10657 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10658 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10659 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10660 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10661 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10662 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10663 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10664
10665 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10666 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10667 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10668 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10669 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10670 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10671 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10672 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10673
10674 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10675 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10676 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10677 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10678 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10679 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10680 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10681 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10682 occurs.
10683
10684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106858.2.3. HTTP log format
10686----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010687
10688The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
10689is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
10690the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
10691are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
10692emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
10693generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
10694"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
10695which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010696frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
10697is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010698
10699Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
10700slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
10701with a star ('*') after the field name below.
10702
10703 Example :
10704 frontend http-in
10705 mode http
10706 option httplog
10707 log global
10708 default_backend bck
10709
10710 backend static
10711 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10712
10713 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10714 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10715 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010716 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010717
10718 Field Format Extract from the example above
10719 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
10720 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
10721 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
10722 4 frontend_name http-in
10723 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
10724 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
10725 7 status_code 200
10726 8 bytes_read* 2750
10727 9 captured_request_cookie -
10728 10 captured_response_cookie -
10729 11 termination_state ----
10730 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
10731 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10732 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
10733 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
10734 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010735
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010736
10737Detailed fields description :
10738 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010739 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10740 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10741 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10742 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10743 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010744
10745 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010746 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10747 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10748 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010749
10750 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
10751 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
10752 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
10753 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
10754 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
10755
10756 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10757 and processed the connection.
10758
10759 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10760 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10761 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
10762
10763 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10764 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10765 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10766 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
10767 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
10768 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
10769
10770 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
10771 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
10772 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
10773 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
10774 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
10775 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
10776
10777 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10778 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10779 See "Timers" below for more details.
10780
10781 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10782 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10783 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
10784 below for more details.
10785
10786 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
10787 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
10788 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10789 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10790 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10791 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10792 for more details.
10793
10794 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10795 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10796 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10797 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10798 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10799 details.
10800
10801 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10802 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10803 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10804
10805 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10806 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10807 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10808 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10809 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10810 overflowing.
10811
10812 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10813 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10814 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10815 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10816 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10817 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10818 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10819 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10820
10821 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10822 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10823 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10824 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10825 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10826 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10827 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10828 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10829
10830 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10831 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10832 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10833 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10834 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10835 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10836 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10837
10838 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010839 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010840 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10841 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10842 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010843 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010844 system.
10845
10846 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10847 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10848 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10849 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10850 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10851 caused by a denial of service attack.
10852
10853 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10854 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10855 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10856 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10857 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10858 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10859 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10860 denial of service attack.
10861
10862 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10863 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10864 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10865 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10866 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10867 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10868 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10869 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10870 processed than on other servers.
10871
10872 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10873 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10874 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10875 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10876 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10877 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10878 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10879 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10880 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10881 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10882 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10883 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10884 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10885
10886 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10887 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10888 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10889 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10890 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10891 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10892 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10893 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10894
10895 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10896 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10897 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10898 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10899 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10900 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10901 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10902 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10903 occurs.
10904
10905 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10906 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10907 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10908 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10909 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10910 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10911 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10912 cookies" below for more details.
10913
10914 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10915 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10916 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10917 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10918 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10919 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10920 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10921 and cookies" below for more details.
10922
10923 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10924 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10925 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10926 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10927 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10928 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10929 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10930 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10931
10932
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200109338.2.4. Custom log format
10934------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010935
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010936The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010937mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010938
10939HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10940Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10941separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10942prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10943
10944Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10945variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10946string formats ("Q").
10947
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010948If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010949as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010950less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
10951the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
10952
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010953Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10954HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10955
10956Flags are :
10957 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010958 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010959
10960 Example:
10961
10962 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10963 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10964
10965At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10966
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010967 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
10968 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010969
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010970the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010971
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010972 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010973 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010974 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010975
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010976and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10977
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010978 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010979 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10980
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010981Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10982
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010983 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010984 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010985 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10986 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10987 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010988 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
10989 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
10990 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010991 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010992 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010993 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010994 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010995 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010996 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010997 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10998 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010999 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011000 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11001 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011002 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011003 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11004 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011005 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11006 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11007 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011008 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011009 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11010 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011011 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011012 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11013 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11014 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011015 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011016 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11017 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11018 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11019 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011020 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011021 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011022 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011023 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011024 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011025 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011026 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11027 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11028 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011029 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011030 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11031 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011032 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011033 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011034 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011035 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011036
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011037 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011038
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011039
110408.2.5. Error log format
11041-----------------------
11042
11043When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11044protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11045By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11046"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11047will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11048logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11049
11050The format looks like this :
11051
11052 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11053 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11054 Connection error during SSL handshake
11055
11056 Field Format Extract from the example above
11057 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11058 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11059 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11060 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11061 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11062
11063These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11064failures.
11065
11066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110678.3. Advanced logging options
11068-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011069
11070Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11071just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11072options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11073for more information about their usage.
11074
11075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110768.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11077------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011078
11079It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11080haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11081commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11082monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11083ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11084
11085 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11086 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11087 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11088 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11089
11090 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11091 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11092 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11093 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11094 such as other load-balancers.
11095
11096 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11097 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11098 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11099
11100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111018.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11102----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011103
11104The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11105what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11106or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11107"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11108just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11109log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11110after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11111is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11112with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11113with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11114
11115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111168.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11117------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011118
11119Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11120for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11121"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11122retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11123raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11124a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11125file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11126you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11127"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11128
11129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111308.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11131--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011132
11133Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11134multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11135them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11136"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11137logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11138error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11139and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11140too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11141useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11142alternative.
11143
11144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111458.4. Timing events
11146------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011147
11148Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11149reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11150the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11151frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11152mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11153
11154 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11155 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11156 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11157 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11158 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11159
11160 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11161 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11162 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11163 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11164 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11165
11166 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11167 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11168 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11169 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11170 connection never established.
11171
11172 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11173 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11174 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11175 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11176 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11177 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11178 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11179 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11180 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11181 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11182 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11183
11184 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11185 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11186 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11187 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11188 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11189
11190 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11191
11192 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11193 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11194 negative.
11195
11196These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11197protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11198that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011199due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011200close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11201session has been aborted on timeout.
11202
11203Most common cases :
11204
11205 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11206 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11207 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11208 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11209 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11210 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11211 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11212 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11213 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011214 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11215 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11216 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011217
11218 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11219 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11220 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11221 of ms on remote networks.
11222
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011223 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11224 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11225 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011226
11227 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11228 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11229 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11230 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11231 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11232 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11233 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11234 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11235 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11236 to the server until another one is released.
11237
11238Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11239
11240 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11241 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11242 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11243
11244 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11245 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11246 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11247
11248 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11249 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11250 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11251 flags.
11252
11253 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11254 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11255 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11256 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11257 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11258 the client connection was maintained open.
11259
11260 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11261 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11262 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11263 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11264
11265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112668.5. Session state at disconnection
11267-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011268
11269TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11270"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
112712-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11272each of which has a special meaning :
11273
11274 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11275 session to terminate :
11276
11277 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11278
11279 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11280 server explicitly refused it.
11281
11282 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11283 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11284 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11285 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011286 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11287
11288 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11289 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011290
11291 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11292 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11293 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11294 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11295 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11296
11297 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11298 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11299 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11300 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11301 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11302
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011303 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11304 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11305
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011306 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11307 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11308 backup connections when going up.
11309
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011310 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11311
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011312 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11313 send or receive data.
11314
11315 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11316 send or receive data.
11317
11318 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11319 with nothing left in the buffers.
11320
11321 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11322
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011323 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011324 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11325
11326 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11327 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11328 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11329 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11330 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11331
11332 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11333 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11334
11335 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11336 server (HTTP only).
11337
11338 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11339
11340 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11341 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11342 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11343
11344 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11345 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11346 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11347
11348 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11349
11350 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11351 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11352
11353 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11354 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11355 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11356
11357 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11358 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011359 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11360 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011361
11362 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11363 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11364 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11365 another server.
11366
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011367 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011368 server.
11369
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011370 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11371 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11372 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11373 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11374
11375 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11376 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11377 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11378 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11379
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011380 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11381 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11382 "use-server" rule).
11383
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011384 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11385
11386 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11387 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11388
11389 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11390
11391 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11392 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11393 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11394
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011395 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11396 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11397 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11398 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11399 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11400
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011401 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11402
11403 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11404 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11405
11406 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11407
11408 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11409
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011410The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11411was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011412helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11413starvation, attacks, etc...
11414
11415The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11416alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11417easier finding and understanding.
11418
11419 Flags Reason
11420
11421 -- Normal termination.
11422
11423 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11424 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11425 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11426 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11427
11428 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11429 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11430 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11431 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11432 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11433 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011434
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011435 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11436 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011437 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011438
11439 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11440 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11441 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11442
11443 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11444 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11445 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11446 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11447 the server takes too long to respond.
11448
11449 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11450 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11451 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11452 long a time to respond.
11453
11454 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11455 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11456 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11457 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11458 and the client.
11459
11460 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11461 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11462 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11463 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11464 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11465 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11466
11467 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11468 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011469 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11470 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11471 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11472 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011473
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011474 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11475 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011477 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011478 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11479 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11480 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11481 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11482 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11483
11484 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11485 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11486 503 or 504 here.
11487
11488 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11489 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11490 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11491 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11492 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11493
11494 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11495 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011496 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011497 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11498 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11499
11500 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11501 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11502 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11503 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11504 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11505 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11506 between haproxy and the server.
11507
11508 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11509 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11510 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11511 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
11512 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
11513 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
11514 solution is to fix the application.
11515
11516 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
11517 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
11518 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
11519 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
11520 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
11521 external attacks.
11522
11523 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
11524 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011525 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011526 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
11527 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
11528
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011529 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
11530 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
11531 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020011532 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
11533 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011534
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011535 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
11536 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
11537 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
11538 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011539 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
11540 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
11541 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
11542 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
11543 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011544
11545 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
11546 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
11547 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
11548 returned an HTTP 403 error.
11549
11550 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
11551 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
11552 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
11553 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
11554
11555 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
11556 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
11557 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
11558 only be solved by proper system tuning.
11559
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011560The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
11561persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
11562important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
11563re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
11564
11565 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
11566
11567 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11568 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
11569 set on a GET request.
11570
11571 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
11572 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011573 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011574 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
11575
11576 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
11577 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
11578 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
11579
11580 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11581 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
11582 already got a cookie.
11583
11584 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11585 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
11586 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
11587 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
11588 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
11589
11590 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11591 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11592 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11593
11594 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
11595 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11596 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11597
11598 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
11599 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
11600
11601 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
11602 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
11603 then advertised in the response.
11604
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116068.6. Non-printable characters
11607-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011608
11609In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
11610consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
11611converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
11612prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
11613being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
11614escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
11615is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
11616'}' when logging headers.
11617
11618Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
11619issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
11620containing spaces is "User-Agent".
11621
11622Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
11623the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
11624performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
11625
11626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116278.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
11628---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011629
11630Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
11631achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011632section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011633cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
11634the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
11635the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011636locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011637not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
11638user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
11639a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
11640wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
11641
11642 Examples :
11643 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
11644 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
11645
11646 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
11647 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
11648
11649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116508.8. Capturing HTTP headers
11651---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011652
11653Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
11654proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
11655the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
11656server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
11657
11658Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
11659response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011660section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011661
11662It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011663time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
11664appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011665are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
11666and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
11667follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
11668request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
11669in the logs.
11670
11671 Example :
11672 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
11673 listen proxy-out
11674 mode http
11675 option httplog
11676 option logasap
11677 log global
11678 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
11679
11680 # log the name of the virtual server
11681 capture request header Host len 20
11682
11683 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
11684 capture request header Content-Length len 10
11685
11686 # log the beginning of the referrer
11687 capture request header Referer len 20
11688
11689 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
11690 capture response header Server len 20
11691
11692 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
11693 capture response header Content-Length len 10
11694
11695 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
11696 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
11697
11698 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
11699 capture response header Via len 20
11700
11701 # log the URL location during a redirection
11702 capture response header Location len 20
11703
11704 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
11705 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
11706 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11707 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
11708 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
11709
11710 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11711 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11712 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11713 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011714 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011715
11716 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11717 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11718 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11719 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
11720 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011721 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011722
11723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117248.9. Examples of logs
11725---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011726
11727These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
11728them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
11729reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
11730
11731 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
11732 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11733 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11734
11735 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
11736 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
11737
11738 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
11739 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
11740 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11741
11742 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
11743 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
11744
11745 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
11746 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11747 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
11748
11749 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011750 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011751 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
11752 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
11753
11754 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
11755 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
11756 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
11757
11758 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
11759 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011760 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011761 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
11762 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
11763 to return the 502 and not the server.
11764
11765 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011766 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011767
11768 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
11769 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
11770 Nothing was sent to any server.
11771
11772 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
11773 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
11774
11775 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
11776 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
11777 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
11778 send a 408 return code to the client.
11779
11780 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
11781 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
11782
11783 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
11784 5 seconds ("c----").
11785
11786 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
11787 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011788 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011789
11790 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011791 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011792 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
11793 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
11794 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
11795 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
11796 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011797
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117999. Statistics and monitoring
11800----------------------------
11801
11802It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11803mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11804CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11805Unix socket.
11806
11807
118089.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011809---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011810
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011811The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11812page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11813
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011814 0. pxname: proxy name
11815 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11816 for server)
11817 2. qcur: current queued requests
11818 3. qmax: max queued requests
11819 4. scur: current sessions
11820 5. smax: max sessions
11821 6. slim: sessions limit
11822 7. stot: total sessions
11823 8. bin: bytes in
11824 9. bout: bytes out
11825 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011826 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011827 12. ereq: request errors
11828 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011829 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011830 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11831 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011832 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011833 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11834 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11835 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11836 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11837 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11838 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11839 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11840 25. qlimit: queue limit
11841 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11842 27. iid: unique proxy id
11843 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11844 29. throttle: warm up status
11845 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11846 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011847 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011848 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11849 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11850 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011851 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011852 UNK -> unknown
11853 INI -> initializing
11854 SOCKERR -> socket error
11855 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11856 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11857 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11858 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11859 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11860 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11861 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11862 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11863 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11864 disable-on-404
11865 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11866 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11867 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011868 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11869 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011870 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11871 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11872 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11873 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11874 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11875 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011876 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11877 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11878 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11879 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011880 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11881 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011882 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11883 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11884 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011885 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011886
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011887
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118889.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011889-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011890
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020011891The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
11892necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
11893A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
11894issuing commands by hand :
11895
11896 global
11897 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
11898 stats timeout 2m
11899
11900It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
11901the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
11902never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
11903situations :
11904
11905 global
11906 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
11907 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
11908 stats timeout 2m
11909
11910To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
11911swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
11912to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
11913syntaxes we'll use are the following :
11914
11915 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
11916 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
11917
11918The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
11919script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
11920for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
11921
11922The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
11923that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
11924editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
11925(eg: watch a counter).
11926
11927The socket supports two operation modes :
11928 - interactive
11929 - non-interactive
11930
11931The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
11932this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
11933sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
11934mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
11935commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
11936example :
11937
11938 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
11939
11940The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
11941entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
11942for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
11943sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
11944"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
11945after processing the last command of the same line.
11946
11947For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
11948"prompt" command :
11949
11950 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
11951 prompt
11952 > show info
11953 ...
11954 >
11955
11956Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
11957delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
11958that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
11959parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011960
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011961It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11962on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11963own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011964
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020011965The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
11966If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
11967all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
11968it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
11969
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011970clear counters
11971 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11972 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11973 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11974 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11975 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11976
11977clear counters all
11978 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11979 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11980 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11981
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011982clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11983 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11984
11985 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11986 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11987 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11988 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11989 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11990 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11991
11992 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11993
11994 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11995 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11996 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11997 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11998 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11999 the ACLs :
12000
12001 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12002 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12003 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12004 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12005 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12006 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12007
12008 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012009 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12010 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012011
12012 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012013 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012014 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012015 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12016 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12017 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12018 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012019
12020 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12021
12022 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012023 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012024 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12025 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012026 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12027 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12028 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012029
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012030disable frontend <frontend>
12031 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12032 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12033 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12034 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12035 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12036 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12037 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12038 on the stats page.
12039
12040 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12041 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12042
12043 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12044 level "admin".
12045
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012046disable server <backend>/<server>
12047 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12048 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12049 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12050 during the maintenance.
12051
12052 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12053 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12054
12055 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012056 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012057
12058 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12059 level "admin".
12060
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012061enable frontend <frontend>
12062 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12063 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12064 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12065 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12066 which was disabled.
12067
12068 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12069 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12070
12071 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12072 level "admin".
12073
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012074enable server <backend>/<server>
12075 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12076 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12077
12078 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012079 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012080
12081 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12082 level "admin".
12083
12084get weight <backend>/<server>
12085 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12086 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12087 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12088 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12089 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012090 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012091
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012092help
12093 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12094 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012095
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012096prompt
12097 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12098 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12099 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12100 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12101 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12102 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12103 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12104 command.
12105
12106quit
12107 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012108
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012109set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012110 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12111 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12112 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12113 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12114 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012115 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12116 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12117
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012118set maxconn global <maxconn>
12119 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12120 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12121 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12122 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12123 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12124 setting.
12125
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012126set rate-limit connections global <value>
12127 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12128 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12129 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12130 is passed in number of connections per second.
12131
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012132set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12133 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12134 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012135 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12136 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012137
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012138set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012139 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12140 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12141 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12142 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012143 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12144 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012145
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012146set timeout cli <delay>
12147 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12148 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12149 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12150
12151set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12152 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12153 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012154 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12155 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12156 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12157 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12158 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12159 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12160 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12161 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12162 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12163 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12164 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12165 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12166 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012167
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012168show errors [<iid>]
12169 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12170 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012171 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12172 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12173 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012174
12175 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12176 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12177 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12178 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12179 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12180 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12181 are reported too.
12182
12183 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12184 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12185 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12186 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12187 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12188 code.
12189
12190 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12191 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12192 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12193 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12194 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12195 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12196 line.
12197
12198 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012199 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12200 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012201 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12202 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12203
12204 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12205 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12206 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12207 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12208 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12209 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12210 00204+ minal\r\n
12211 00211 \r\n
12212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012213 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012214 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12215 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12216 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12217 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12218 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12219 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012220
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012221show info
12222 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12223
12224show sess
12225 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012226 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12227 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12228
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012229show sess <id>
12230 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12231 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12232 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12233 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12234 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012235 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12236 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12237 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012238
12239show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12240 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12241 possible to dump only selected items :
12242 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12243 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12244 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12245 for example:
12246 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12247 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12248 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12249
12250 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012251 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12252 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012253 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12254 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12255 Nbproc: 1
12256 Process_num: 1
12257 (...)
12258
12259 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12260 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12261 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12262 (...)
12263 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12264
12265 $
12266
12267 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12268 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12269 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12270 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012271 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012272
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012273show table
12274 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12275 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12276 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12277 entries currently in use.
12278
12279 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012280 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012281 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12282 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012283
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012284show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012285 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12286 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12287 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012288 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12289
12290 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12291 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12292 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12293 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12294 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12295
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012296 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12297 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12298 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12299 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12300 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12301 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12302
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012303
12304 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012305 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12306 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012307
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012308 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012309 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012310 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012311 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12312 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12313 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12314 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012315
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012316 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012317 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012318 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12319 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012320
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012321 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12322 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012323 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012324 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12325 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012326
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012327 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12328 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012329 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012330 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12331 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12332
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012333 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12334 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12335 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12336 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12337 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12338
12339 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12340 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12341 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012342 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12343 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012344 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12345 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012346
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012347shutdown frontend <frontend>
12348 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12349 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12350 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12351 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12352 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12353 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12354 once it is terminated.
12355
12356 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12357 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12358
12359 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12360 level "admin".
12361
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012362shutdown session <id>
12363 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12364 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12365 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12366 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12367 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12368 flag in the logs.
12369
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012370shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12371 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12372 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12373 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12374 'K' flag in the logs.
12375
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012376/*
12377 * Local variables:
12378 * fill-column: 79
12379 * End:
12380 */